(ffap): Don't hide it behind the autoload-cookie.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobd66f719fc9f0be54a79105eefadb612815878cfb
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_LUCID
101 extern int xlwmenu_window_p (Widget w, Window window);
102 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
103 #endif
105 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
107 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
108 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
109 int));
111 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
112 #define HACK_EDITRES
113 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
114 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
116 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
118 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
119 #if defined USE_MOTIF
120 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
121 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
122 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
124 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
125 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
126 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
127 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
128 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
129 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
130 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
131 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
132 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
133 #ifndef XtNpickTop
134 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
135 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
136 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
137 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
139 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
141 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
142 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
143 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
144 #endif
146 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
147 #include "widget.h"
148 #ifndef XtNinitialState
149 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
150 #endif
151 #endif
153 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
155 #define BETWEEN(X, LOWER, UPPER) ((X) >= (LOWER) && (X) < (UPPER))
158 /* Fringe bitmaps. */
160 enum fringe_bitmap_type
162 NO_FRINGE_BITMAP,
163 LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
164 RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
165 OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP,
166 CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP,
167 CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP,
168 ZV_LINE_BITMAP
171 /* Bitmap drawn to indicate lines not displaying text if
172 `indicate-empty-lines' is non-nil. */
174 #define zv_width 8
175 #define zv_height 72
176 #define zv_period 3
177 static unsigned char zv_bits[] = {
178 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
179 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
180 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
181 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
182 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
183 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
184 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00,
185 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x3c, 0x00};
187 /* An arrow like this: `<-'. */
189 #define left_width 8
190 #define left_height 8
191 static unsigned char left_bits[] = {
192 0x18, 0x0c, 0x06, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x06, 0x0c, 0x18};
194 /* Right truncation arrow bitmap `->'. */
196 #define right_width 8
197 #define right_height 8
198 static unsigned char right_bits[] = {
199 0x18, 0x30, 0x60, 0xfc, 0xfc, 0x60, 0x30, 0x18};
201 /* Marker for continued lines. */
203 #define continued_width 8
204 #define continued_height 8
205 static unsigned char continued_bits[] = {
206 0x3c, 0x7c, 0xc0, 0xe4, 0xfc, 0x7c, 0x3c, 0x7c};
208 /* Marker for continuation lines. */
210 #define continuation_width 8
211 #define continuation_height 8
212 static unsigned char continuation_bits[] = {
213 0x3c, 0x3e, 0x03, 0x27, 0x3f, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x3e};
215 /* Overlay arrow bitmap. */
217 #if 0
218 /* A bomb. */
219 #define ov_width 8
220 #define ov_height 8
221 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
222 0x30, 0x08, 0x3c, 0x7e, 0x7a, 0x7a, 0x62, 0x3c};
223 #else
224 /* A triangular arrow. */
225 #define ov_width 8
226 #define ov_height 8
227 static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
228 0x03, 0x0f, 0x1f, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x1f, 0x0f, 0x03};
230 #endif
232 extern Lisp_Object Qhelp_echo;
235 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
237 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
239 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
240 (The display is done in read_char.) */
242 static Lisp_Object help_echo;
243 static Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
244 static Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
245 static int help_echo_pos;
247 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
249 static Lisp_Object previous_help_echo;
251 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
252 start. */
254 static int any_help_event_p;
256 /* Non-zero means autoselect window with the mouse cursor. */
258 int mouse_autoselect_window;
260 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
261 static Lisp_Object last_window;
263 /* Non-zero means draw block and hollow cursor as wide as the glyph
264 under it. For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be
265 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. */
267 int x_stretch_cursor_p;
269 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
271 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
273 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
274 use. */
276 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
278 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
279 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
280 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
281 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
283 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
285 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
286 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
287 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
288 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
290 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
292 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
294 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
296 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
297 /* The application context for Xt use. */
298 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
299 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
300 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
302 /* Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
303 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
304 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
306 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
308 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
310 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
312 /* Mouse movement.
314 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
315 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
316 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
317 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
319 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
321 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
322 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
323 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
324 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
325 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
326 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
327 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
328 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
329 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
330 is off. */
332 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
334 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
335 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
336 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
338 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
340 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
341 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
342 an ordinary motion.
344 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
345 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
346 event. */
348 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
350 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
351 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
352 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
353 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
354 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
355 it's somewhat accurate. */
357 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
359 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
360 events. */
362 #ifdef __STDC__
363 static int volatile input_signal_count;
364 #else
365 static int input_signal_count;
366 #endif
368 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
370 static int x_noop_count;
372 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
374 extern char **initial_argv;
375 extern int initial_argc;
377 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
379 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
381 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
383 extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face;
385 extern int errno;
387 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
389 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
391 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
393 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
394 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
396 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
397 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1, Qutf_8;
399 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
400 extern Lisp_Object x_icon_type P_ ((struct frame *));
403 /* Enumeration for overriding/changing the face to use for drawing
404 glyphs in x_draw_glyphs. */
406 enum draw_glyphs_face
408 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
409 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO,
410 DRAW_CURSOR,
411 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE,
412 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED,
413 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
416 static int cursor_in_mouse_face_p P_ ((struct window *));
417 static int clear_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
418 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
419 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
420 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
421 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
422 static void frame_to_window_pixel_xy P_ ((struct window *, int *, int *));
423 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
424 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
425 unsigned));
426 static int fast_find_position P_ ((struct window *, int, int *, int *,
427 int *, int *, Lisp_Object));
428 static int fast_find_string_pos P_ ((struct window *, int, Lisp_Object,
429 int *, int *, int *, int *, int));
430 static void set_output_cursor P_ ((struct cursor_pos *));
431 static struct glyph *x_y_to_hpos_vpos P_ ((struct window *, int, int,
432 int *, int *, int *, int));
433 static void note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight P_ ((struct window *, int,
434 int, int));
435 static void note_mouse_highlight P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
436 static void note_tool_bar_highlight P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int));
437 static void x_handle_tool_bar_click P_ ((struct frame *, XButtonEvent *));
438 static void show_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
439 enum draw_glyphs_face));
440 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
441 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
442 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
443 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
444 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
445 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
446 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
447 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
448 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
449 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
450 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
451 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
452 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
453 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
454 static void x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph P_ ((struct window *,
455 struct glyph_row *,
456 enum draw_glyphs_face));
457 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
458 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
459 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
460 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
461 static void XTcursor_to P_ ((int, int, int, int));
462 static void x_write_glyphs P_ ((struct glyph *, int));
463 static void x_clear_end_of_line P_ ((int));
464 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
465 static void x_clear_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
466 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
467 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
468 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
469 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
470 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
471 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
472 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
473 enum text_cursor_kinds));
474 static int x_intersect_rectangles P_ ((XRectangle *, XRectangle *,
475 XRectangle *));
476 static void expose_frame P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int));
477 static int expose_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
478 static int expose_window P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
479 static void expose_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
480 XRectangle *, enum glyph_row_area));
481 static int expose_line P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
482 XRectangle *));
483 static void x_update_cursor_in_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, int));
484 static void x_update_window_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int));
485 static void x_erase_phys_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
486 void x_display_and_set_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int, int, int, int, int));
487 static void x_draw_fringe_bitmap P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
488 enum fringe_bitmap_type, int left_p));
490 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
491 GC, int));
492 static int x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p P_ ((struct window *, XRectangle *));
493 static void x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
494 static void notice_overwritten_cursor P_ ((struct window *, enum glyph_row_area,
495 int, int, int, int));
496 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
497 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
498 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
499 static void x_draw_vertical_border P_ ((struct window *));
500 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
501 static INLINE void take_vertical_position_into_account P_ ((struct it *));
502 static void x_produce_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
503 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Window));
504 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
505 enum scroll_bar_part *,
506 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
507 unsigned long *));
508 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
509 static void x_check_fullscreen_move P_ ((struct frame *));
511 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
513 static void
514 x_flush (f)
515 struct frame *f;
517 BLOCK_INPUT;
518 if (f == NULL)
520 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
521 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
522 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
524 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
525 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
530 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
531 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
532 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
533 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
534 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
535 performance. */
537 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
540 /***********************************************************************
541 Debugging
542 ***********************************************************************/
544 #if 0
546 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
547 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
549 struct record
551 char *locus;
552 int type;
555 struct record event_record[100];
557 int event_record_index;
559 record_event (locus, type)
560 char *locus;
561 int type;
563 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
564 event_record_index = 0;
566 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
567 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
568 event_record_index++;
571 #endif /* 0 */
575 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
577 struct x_display_info *
578 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
579 Display *dpy;
581 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
583 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
584 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
585 return dpyinfo;
587 return 0;
592 /***********************************************************************
593 Starting and ending an update
594 ***********************************************************************/
596 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
597 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
598 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
599 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
600 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
602 static void
603 x_update_begin (f)
604 struct frame *f;
606 /* Nothing to do. */
610 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
611 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
612 position of W. */
614 static void
615 x_update_window_begin (w)
616 struct window *w;
618 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
619 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
621 updated_window = w;
622 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
624 BLOCK_INPUT;
626 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
628 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
629 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
631 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
632 highlighting. */
633 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
634 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
636 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
637 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
638 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
639 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
640 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
641 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
643 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
644 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
645 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
646 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
647 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
648 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
649 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
651 int i;
653 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
654 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
655 break;
657 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
658 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
660 #endif /* 0 */
663 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
667 /* Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
668 have vertical scroll bars. */
670 static void
671 x_draw_vertical_border (w)
672 struct window *w;
674 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
676 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
677 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
678 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
679 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
680 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
681 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
683 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
685 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
686 x1 += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
687 y1 -= 1;
689 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
690 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x1, y0, x1, y1);
695 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
697 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
698 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
700 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
701 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
702 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
704 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
705 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
706 here. */
708 static void
709 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
710 struct window *w;
711 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
713 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
715 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
717 BLOCK_INPUT;
719 if (cursor_on_p)
720 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
721 output_cursor.vpos,
722 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
724 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
725 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
728 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
729 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
730 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
732 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
733 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
734 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
737 updated_window = NULL;
741 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
742 update_end. */
744 static void
745 x_update_end (f)
746 struct frame *f;
748 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
749 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
751 BLOCK_INPUT;
752 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
753 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
757 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
758 complete update has been performed. The global variable
759 updated_window is not available here. */
761 static void
762 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
763 struct frame *f;
765 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
767 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
769 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
770 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
772 BLOCK_INPUT;
773 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
774 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
775 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
776 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
777 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
778 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
784 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
785 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
786 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
787 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
788 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
789 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
791 static void
792 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
793 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
795 struct window *w = updated_window;
796 struct frame *f;
797 int width, height;
799 xassert (w);
801 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
803 BLOCK_INPUT;
804 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
805 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
808 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
809 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
810 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
811 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
812 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
813 overhead is very small. */
814 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
815 && desired_row->full_width_p
816 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
817 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
818 width != 0)
819 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
820 height > 0))
822 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
824 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
825 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
826 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
827 y -= width;
829 BLOCK_INPUT;
830 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
831 0, y, width, height, False);
832 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
833 f->output_data.x->pixel_width - width,
834 y, width, height, False);
835 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
840 /* Draw the bitmap WHICH in one of the left or right fringes of
841 window W. ROW is the glyph row for which to display the bitmap; it
842 determines the vertical position at which the bitmap has to be
843 drawn. */
845 static void
846 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, which, left_p)
847 struct window *w;
848 struct glyph_row *row;
849 enum fringe_bitmap_type which;
850 int left_p;
852 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
853 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
854 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
855 int x, y, wd, h, dy;
856 int b1, b2;
857 unsigned char *bits = NULL;
858 Pixmap pixmap;
859 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
860 struct face *face;
861 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
863 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
864 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 1);
866 /* Convert row to frame coordinates. */
867 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
869 switch (which)
871 case NO_FRINGE_BITMAP:
872 wd = 0;
873 h = 0;
874 break;
876 case LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
877 wd = left_width;
878 h = left_height;
879 bits = left_bits;
880 break;
882 case OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP:
883 wd = ov_width;
884 h = ov_height;
885 bits = ov_bits;
886 break;
888 case RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
889 wd = right_width;
890 h = right_height;
891 bits = right_bits;
892 break;
894 case CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP:
895 wd = continued_width;
896 h = continued_height;
897 bits = continued_bits;
898 break;
900 case CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP:
901 wd = continuation_width;
902 h = continuation_height;
903 bits = continuation_bits;
904 break;
906 case ZV_LINE_BITMAP:
907 wd = zv_width;
908 h = zv_height - (y % zv_period);
909 bits = zv_bits + (y % zv_period);
910 break;
912 default:
913 abort ();
916 /* Clip bitmap if too high. */
917 if (h > row->height)
918 h = row->height;
920 /* Set dy to the offset in the row to start drawing the bitmap. */
921 dy = (row->height - h) / 2;
923 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, FRINGE_FACE_ID);
924 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
926 /* Clear left fringe if no bitmap to draw or if bitmap doesn't fill
927 the fringe. */
928 b1 = b2 = -1;
929 if (left_p)
931 if (wd > FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f))
932 wd = FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
933 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
934 - wd
935 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
936 if (wd < FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) || row->height > h)
938 /* If W has a vertical border to its left, don't draw over it. */
939 int border = ((XFASTINT (w->left) > 0
940 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
941 ? 1 : 0);
942 b1 = (window_box_left (w, -1)
943 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f)
944 + border);
945 b2 = (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - border);
948 else
950 if (wd > FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f))
951 wd = FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
952 x = (window_box_right (w, -1)
953 + (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
954 /* Clear right fringe if no bitmap to draw of if bitmap doesn't fill
955 the fringe. */
956 if (wd < FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) || row->height > h)
958 b1 = window_box_right (w, -1);
959 b2 = FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
963 if (b1 >= 0)
965 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
967 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
968 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
969 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
970 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
971 if (face->stipple)
972 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
973 else
974 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
976 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
978 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
979 row->y)),
981 row->visible_height);
982 if (!face->stipple)
983 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
986 if (which != NO_FRINGE_BITMAP)
988 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
989 by the server. */
990 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, wd, h,
991 face->foreground,
992 face->background, depth);
993 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0, wd, h, x, y + dy);
994 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
997 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
1001 /* Draw fringe bitmaps for glyph row ROW on window W. Call this
1002 function with input blocked. */
1004 static void
1005 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row)
1006 struct window *w;
1007 struct glyph_row *row;
1009 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1010 enum fringe_bitmap_type bitmap;
1012 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
1014 /* If row is completely invisible, because of vscrolling, we
1015 don't have to draw anything. */
1016 if (row->visible_height <= 0)
1017 return;
1019 if (FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) != 0)
1021 /* Decide which bitmap to draw in the left fringe. */
1022 if (row->overlay_arrow_p)
1023 bitmap = OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP;
1024 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p)
1025 bitmap = LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1026 else if (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row))
1027 bitmap = CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP;
1028 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p)
1029 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
1030 else
1031 bitmap = NO_FRINGE_BITMAP;
1033 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, bitmap, 1);
1036 if (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) != 0)
1038 /* Decide which bitmap to draw in the right fringe. */
1039 if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
1040 bitmap = RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1041 else if (row->continued_p)
1042 bitmap = CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP;
1043 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p && FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) == 0)
1044 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
1045 else
1046 bitmap = NO_FRINGE_BITMAP;
1048 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, bitmap, 0);
1054 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
1055 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
1056 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
1057 rarely happens). */
1059 static void
1060 XTset_terminal_modes ()
1064 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
1065 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
1067 static void
1068 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
1074 /***********************************************************************
1075 Output Cursor
1076 ***********************************************************************/
1078 /* Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
1079 positions are relative to updated_window. */
1081 static void
1082 set_output_cursor (cursor)
1083 struct cursor_pos *cursor;
1085 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
1086 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
1087 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
1088 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
1092 /* Set a nominal cursor position.
1094 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
1095 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
1097 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
1098 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
1099 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
1100 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
1102 static void
1103 XTcursor_to (vpos, hpos, y, x)
1104 int vpos, hpos, y, x;
1106 struct window *w;
1108 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
1109 if (updated_window)
1110 w = updated_window;
1111 else
1112 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
1114 /* Set the output cursor. */
1115 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
1116 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
1117 output_cursor.x = x;
1118 output_cursor.y = y;
1120 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
1121 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
1122 if (updated_window == NULL)
1124 BLOCK_INPUT;
1125 x_display_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
1126 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (SELECTED_FRAME ()));
1127 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1133 /***********************************************************************
1134 Display Iterator
1135 ***********************************************************************/
1137 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
1139 static struct face *x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *,
1140 struct glyph *,
1141 XChar2b *,
1142 int *));
1143 static struct face *x_get_char_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *, int,
1144 int, XChar2b *, int,
1145 int));
1146 static XCharStruct *x_per_char_metric P_ ((XFontStruct *, XChar2b *));
1147 static void x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *));
1148 static void x_append_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1149 static void x_append_composite_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1150 static void x_append_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *it, Lisp_Object,
1151 int, int, double));
1152 static void x_produce_glyphs P_ ((struct it *));
1153 static void x_produce_image_glyph P_ ((struct it *it));
1156 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
1157 is not contained in the font. */
1159 static INLINE XCharStruct *
1160 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b)
1161 XFontStruct *font;
1162 XChar2b *char2b;
1164 /* The result metric information. */
1165 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
1167 xassert (font && char2b);
1169 if (font->per_char != NULL)
1171 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
1173 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
1174 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
1175 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
1176 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
1177 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
1178 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
1179 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
1180 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1181 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1182 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
1184 else
1186 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
1187 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
1188 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
1189 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
1191 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
1192 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
1194 where:
1196 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
1197 / = integer division
1198 \ = integer modulus */
1199 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
1200 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
1201 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1202 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1204 pcm = (font->per_char
1205 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
1206 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
1207 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
1211 else
1213 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
1214 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
1215 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
1216 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1217 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1218 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
1221 return ((pcm == NULL
1222 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
1223 ? NULL : pcm);
1227 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
1228 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
1230 static INLINE void
1231 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info)
1232 int c;
1233 XChar2b *char2b;
1234 struct font_info *font_info;
1236 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
1237 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
1239 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
1240 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
1241 fixed encoding. */
1242 if (font_info->font_encoder)
1244 /* It's a program. */
1245 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
1247 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
1249 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1250 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
1252 else
1254 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1255 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
1256 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
1259 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
1261 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
1262 program. */
1263 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
1264 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
1265 else
1266 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
1268 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
1270 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
1271 encoding numbers. */
1272 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
1274 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
1275 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
1276 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
1278 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
1279 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
1284 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame
1285 F. The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1286 means we want to display multibyte text. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
1287 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
1288 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
1289 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
1291 static INLINE struct face *
1292 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (f, c, face_id, char2b, multibyte_p, display_p)
1293 struct frame *f;
1294 int c, face_id;
1295 XChar2b *char2b;
1296 int multibyte_p, display_p;
1298 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1300 if (!multibyte_p)
1302 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1303 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1304 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1305 char2b->byte2 = c;
1306 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, c);
1307 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1309 else if (c < 128 && face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1311 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1312 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1313 char2b->byte2 = c;
1315 else
1317 int c1, c2, charset;
1319 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1320 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1321 SPLIT_CHAR (c, charset, c1, c2);
1322 if (c2 > 0)
1323 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1324 else
1325 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1327 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1328 if (face->font != NULL)
1330 struct font_info *font_info
1331 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1332 if (font_info)
1333 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info);
1337 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1338 if (display_p)
1340 xassert (face != NULL);
1341 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1344 return face;
1348 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
1349 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
1350 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
1352 static INLINE struct face *
1353 x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, char2b, two_byte_p)
1354 struct frame *f;
1355 struct glyph *glyph;
1356 XChar2b *char2b;
1357 int *two_byte_p;
1359 struct face *face;
1361 xassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
1362 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
1364 if (two_byte_p)
1365 *two_byte_p = 0;
1367 if (!glyph->multibyte_p)
1369 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1370 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1371 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1372 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1374 else if (glyph->u.ch < 128
1375 && glyph->face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1377 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1378 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1379 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1381 else
1383 int c1, c2, charset;
1385 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1386 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1387 SPLIT_CHAR (glyph->u.ch, charset, c1, c2);
1388 if (c2 > 0)
1389 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1390 else
1391 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1393 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1394 if (charset != CHARSET_ASCII)
1396 struct font_info *font_info
1397 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1398 if (font_info)
1400 x_encode_char (glyph->u.ch, char2b, font_info);
1401 if (two_byte_p)
1402 *two_byte_p
1403 = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
1408 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1409 xassert (face != NULL);
1410 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1411 return face;
1415 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
1416 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1418 static INLINE void
1419 x_append_glyph (it)
1420 struct it *it;
1422 struct glyph *glyph;
1423 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1425 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1426 xassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
1428 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1429 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1431 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1432 glyph->object = it->object;
1433 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1434 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1435 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
1436 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1437 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1438 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1439 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1440 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1441 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1442 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
1443 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1444 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
1445 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1449 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_id in IT->glyph_row.
1450 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1452 static INLINE void
1453 x_append_composite_glyph (it)
1454 struct it *it;
1456 struct glyph *glyph;
1457 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1459 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1461 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1462 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1464 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1465 glyph->object = it->object;
1466 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1467 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1468 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
1469 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1470 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1471 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1472 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1473 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1474 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1475 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1476 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1477 glyph->u.cmp_id = it->cmp_id;
1478 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1483 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
1484 IT->voffset. */
1486 static INLINE void
1487 take_vertical_position_into_account (it)
1488 struct it *it;
1490 if (it->voffset)
1492 if (it->voffset < 0)
1493 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
1494 in the line. */
1495 it->ascent += abs (it->voffset);
1496 else
1497 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
1498 in the line. */
1499 it->descent += it->voffset;
1504 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
1505 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
1506 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1508 static void
1509 x_produce_image_glyph (it)
1510 struct it *it;
1512 struct image *img;
1513 struct face *face;
1515 xassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
1517 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1518 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
1519 xassert (img);
1521 /* Make sure X resources of the face and image are loaded. */
1522 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1523 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
1525 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = image_ascent (img, face);
1526 it->descent = it->phys_descent = img->height + 2 * img->vmargin - it->ascent;
1527 it->pixel_width = img->width + 2 * img->hmargin;
1529 it->nglyphs = 1;
1531 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1533 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1535 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1536 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1539 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1540 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1541 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1542 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1545 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1547 if (it->glyph_row)
1549 struct glyph *glyph;
1550 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1552 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1553 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1555 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1556 glyph->object = it->object;
1557 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1558 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1559 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
1560 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1561 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1562 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1563 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1564 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1565 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1566 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1567 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
1568 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1574 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
1575 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
1576 stretch. ASCENT is the percentage/100 of HEIGHT to use for the
1577 ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= 1). */
1579 static void
1580 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent)
1581 struct it *it;
1582 Lisp_Object object;
1583 int width, height;
1584 double ascent;
1586 struct glyph *glyph;
1587 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1589 xassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= 1);
1591 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1592 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1594 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1595 glyph->object = object;
1596 glyph->pixel_width = width;
1597 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1598 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
1599 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1600 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1601 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1602 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
1603 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1604 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1605 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1606 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = height * ascent;
1607 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
1608 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1613 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
1614 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
1615 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
1616 being recognized:
1618 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
1619 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
1620 point number.
1622 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
1623 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
1624 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
1626 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
1627 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
1629 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
1631 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
1632 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
1634 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
1635 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
1636 the glyph property.
1638 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
1640 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
1641 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
1642 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
1644 #define NUMVAL(X) \
1645 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
1646 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
1647 : - 1)
1650 static void
1651 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it)
1652 struct it *it;
1654 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT. */
1655 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
1656 extern Lisp_Object Qspace;
1657 #endif
1658 extern Lisp_Object QCwidth, QCheight, QCascent;
1659 extern Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
1660 extern Lisp_Object QCalign_to;
1661 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
1662 double width = 0, height = 0, ascent = 0;
1663 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1664 XFontStruct *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1666 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
1668 /* List should start with `space'. */
1669 xassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
1670 plist = XCDR (it->object);
1672 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
1673 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth),
1674 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1675 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
1676 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1677 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width),
1678 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1680 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
1681 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
1682 property. */
1683 struct it it2;
1684 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1686 it2 = *it;
1687 if (it->multibyte_p)
1689 int maxlen = ((IT_BYTEPOS (*it) >= GPT ? ZV : GPT)
1690 - IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
1691 it2.c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, maxlen, it2.len);
1693 else
1694 it2.c = *p, it2.len = 1;
1696 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
1697 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
1698 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
1699 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
1701 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to),
1702 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1703 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f) - it->current_x;
1704 else
1705 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
1706 width = CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1708 /* Compute height. */
1709 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight),
1710 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1711 height = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_Y_UNIT (it->f);
1712 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
1713 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
1714 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
1715 else
1716 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1718 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
1719 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
1720 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
1721 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
1722 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
1723 ascent = NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
1724 else
1725 ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1727 if (width <= 0)
1728 width = 1;
1729 if (height <= 0)
1730 height = 1;
1732 if (it->glyph_row)
1734 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
1735 if (!STRINGP (object))
1736 object = it->w->buffer;
1737 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
1740 it->pixel_width = width;
1741 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = height * ascent;
1742 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
1743 it->nglyphs = 1;
1745 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1747 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1749 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1750 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1753 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1754 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1755 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1756 it->pixel_width += abs (face->box_line_width);
1759 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1762 /* Return proper value to be used as baseline offset of font that has
1763 ASCENT and DESCENT to draw characters by the font at the vertical
1764 center of the line of frame F.
1766 Here, out task is to find the value of BOFF in the following figure;
1768 -------------------------+-----------+-
1769 -+-+---------+-+ | |
1770 | | | | | |
1771 | | | | F_ASCENT F_HEIGHT
1772 | | | ASCENT | |
1773 HEIGHT | | | | |
1774 | | |-|-+------+-----------|------- baseline
1775 | | | | BOFF | |
1776 | |---------|-+-+ | |
1777 | | | DESCENT | |
1778 -+-+---------+-+ F_DESCENT |
1779 -------------------------+-----------+-
1781 -BOFF + DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 = F_DESCENT
1782 BOFF = DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 - F_DESCENT
1783 DESCENT = FONT->descent
1784 HEIGHT = FONT_HEIGHT (FONT)
1785 F_DESCENT = (F->output_data.x->font->descent
1786 - F->output_data.x->baseline_offset)
1787 F_HEIGHT = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (F)
1790 #define VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET(FONT, F) \
1791 ((FONT)->descent \
1792 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) - FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)) \
1793 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) > FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT)))) / 2 \
1794 - ((F)->output_data.x->font->descent - (F)->output_data.x->baseline_offset))
1796 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
1797 loaded with. See the description of struct display_iterator in
1798 dispextern.h for an overview of struct display_iterator. */
1800 static void
1801 x_produce_glyphs (it)
1802 struct it *it;
1804 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
1806 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
1808 XChar2b char2b;
1809 XFontStruct *font;
1810 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1811 XCharStruct *pcm;
1812 int font_not_found_p;
1813 struct font_info *font_info;
1814 int boff; /* baseline offset */
1815 /* We may change it->multibyte_p upon unibyte<->multibyte
1816 conversion. So, save the current value now and restore it
1817 later.
1819 Note: It seems that we don't have to record multibyte_p in
1820 struct glyph because the character code itself tells if or
1821 not the character is multibyte. Thus, in the future, we must
1822 consider eliminating the field `multibyte_p' in the struct
1823 glyph. */
1824 int saved_multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1826 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte, or the
1827 other way. */
1828 it->char_to_display = it->c;
1829 if (!ASCII_BYTE_P (it->c))
1831 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
1832 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1833 && (it->c >= 0240
1834 || !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table)))
1836 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
1837 it->multibyte_p = 1;
1838 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1839 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1841 else if (!SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
1842 && !it->multibyte_p)
1844 it->multibyte_p = 1;
1845 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
1846 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
1850 /* Get font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
1851 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
1852 it->face_id, &char2b,
1853 it->multibyte_p, 0);
1854 font = face->font;
1856 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
1857 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
1858 if (font_not_found_p)
1860 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
1861 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
1862 font_info = NULL;
1864 else
1866 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
1867 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
1868 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
1869 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
1872 if (it->char_to_display >= ' '
1873 && (!it->multibyte_p || it->char_to_display < 128))
1875 /* Either unibyte or ASCII. */
1876 int stretched_p;
1878 it->nglyphs = 1;
1880 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
1881 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1882 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
1884 if (pcm)
1886 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
1887 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
1888 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
1890 else
1892 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
1893 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1894 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1895 it->pixel_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
1898 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
1899 `space-width' property, change its width. */
1900 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
1901 if (stretched_p)
1902 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
1904 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
1905 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
1906 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
1907 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
1909 int thick = face->box_line_width;
1911 if (thick > 0)
1913 it->ascent += thick;
1914 it->descent += thick;
1916 else
1917 thick = -thick;
1919 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
1920 it->pixel_width += thick;
1921 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
1922 it->pixel_width += thick;
1925 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
1926 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
1927 if (face->overline_p)
1928 it->ascent += 2;
1930 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
1932 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
1933 if (it->glyph_row)
1935 if (stretched_p)
1937 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
1938 into a stretch glyph. */
1939 double ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
1940 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
1941 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
1943 else
1944 x_append_glyph (it);
1946 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
1947 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
1948 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
1949 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
1950 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
1953 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
1955 /* A newline has no width but we need the height of the line. */
1956 it->pixel_width = 0;
1957 it->nglyphs = 0;
1958 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1959 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1961 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1962 && face->box_line_width > 0)
1964 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
1965 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
1968 else if (it->char_to_display == '\t')
1970 int tab_width = it->tab_width * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
1971 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
1972 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
1974 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
1975 stop is less than a canonical character width, use the
1976 tab stop after that. */
1977 if (next_tab_x - x < CANON_X_UNIT (it->f))
1978 next_tab_x += tab_width;
1980 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
1981 it->nglyphs = 1;
1982 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
1983 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
1985 if (it->glyph_row)
1987 double ascent = (double) it->ascent / (it->ascent + it->descent);
1988 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
1989 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
1992 else
1994 /* A multi-byte character. Assume that the display width of the
1995 character is the width of the character multiplied by the
1996 width of the font. */
1998 /* If we found a font, this font should give us the right
1999 metrics. If we didn't find a font, use the frame's
2000 default font and calculate the width of the character
2001 from the charset width; this is what old redisplay code
2002 did. */
2003 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2004 if (font_not_found_p || !pcm)
2006 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (it->char_to_display);
2008 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
2009 it->pixel_width = (FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (it->f))
2010 * CHARSET_WIDTH (charset));
2011 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2012 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2014 else
2016 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
2017 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
2018 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
2019 if (it->glyph_row
2020 && (pcm->lbearing < 0
2021 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
2022 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
2024 it->nglyphs = 1;
2025 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2026 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
2027 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2029 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2031 if (thick > 0)
2033 it->ascent += thick;
2034 it->descent += thick;
2036 else
2037 thick = - thick;
2039 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2040 it->pixel_width += thick;
2041 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2042 it->pixel_width += thick;
2045 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2046 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2047 if (face->overline_p)
2048 it->ascent += 2;
2050 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2052 if (it->glyph_row)
2053 x_append_glyph (it);
2055 it->multibyte_p = saved_multibyte_p;
2057 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
2059 /* Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
2060 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs. */
2061 XChar2b char2b;
2062 XFontStruct *font;
2063 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2064 XCharStruct *pcm;
2065 int font_not_found_p;
2066 struct font_info *font_info;
2067 int boff; /* baseline offset */
2068 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_id];
2070 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte. */
2071 it->char_to_display = it->c;
2072 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
2073 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
2074 && (it->c >= 0240
2075 || (it->c >= 0200
2076 && !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table))))
2078 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
2081 /* Get face and font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
2082 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
2083 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2084 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
2085 it->face_id, &char2b, it->multibyte_p, 0);
2086 font = face->font;
2088 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
2089 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
2090 if (font_not_found_p)
2092 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2093 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2094 font_info = NULL;
2096 else
2098 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2099 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2100 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2101 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2104 /* There are no padding glyphs, so there is only one glyph to
2105 produce for the composition. Important is that pixel_width,
2106 ascent and descent are the values of what is drawn by
2107 draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of the overall glyphs composed). */
2108 it->nglyphs = 1;
2110 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
2111 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
2112 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
2113 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
2114 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This leads
2115 to incorrect display very rarely, and C-l (recenter) can
2116 correct the display anyway. */
2117 if (cmp->font != (void *) font)
2119 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character of
2120 this composition (adjusted by baseline offset). Ascent
2121 and descent of overall glyphs should not be less than
2122 them respectively. */
2123 int font_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2124 int font_descent = font->descent - boff;
2125 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2126 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
2127 int i, width, ascent, descent;
2129 cmp->font = (void *) font;
2131 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
2132 if (font_info
2133 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2135 width = pcm->width;
2136 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2137 descent = pcm->descent;
2139 else
2141 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2142 ascent = font->ascent;
2143 descent = font->descent;
2146 rightmost = width;
2147 lowest = - descent + boff;
2148 highest = ascent + boff;
2149 leftmost = 0;
2151 if (font_info
2152 && font_info->default_ascent
2153 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
2154 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
2155 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
2156 highest = font_info->default_ascent + boff;
2158 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
2159 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn at
2160 the left. */
2161 cmp->offsets[0] = 0;
2162 cmp->offsets[1] = boff;
2164 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
2165 for (i = 1; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2167 int left, right, btm, top;
2168 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
2169 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch);
2171 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
2172 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face->id, &char2b,
2173 it->multibyte_p, 0);
2174 font = face->font;
2175 if (font == NULL)
2177 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2178 boff = it->f->output_data.x->baseline_offset;
2179 font_info = NULL;
2181 else
2183 font_info
2184 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2185 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2186 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2187 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2190 if (font_info
2191 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2193 width = pcm->width;
2194 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2195 descent = pcm->descent;
2197 else
2199 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2200 ascent = 1;
2201 descent = 0;
2204 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
2206 /* Relative composition with or without
2207 alternate chars. */
2208 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
2209 btm = - descent + boff;
2210 if (font_info && font_info->relative_compose
2211 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
2212 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
2213 make_number (ch)))))
2216 if (- descent >= font_info->relative_compose)
2217 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2218 btm = highest + 1;
2219 else if (ascent <= 0)
2220 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2221 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
2224 else
2226 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
2227 value that encodes global and new reference
2228 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
2229 specified by numbers as below:
2231 0---1---2 -- ascent
2235 9--10--11 -- center
2237 ---3---4---5--- baseline
2239 6---7---8 -- descent
2241 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
2242 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy;
2244 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref);
2245 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
2246 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
2248 left = (leftmost
2249 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
2250 - nrefx * width / 2);
2251 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
2252 : grefy == 1 ? 0
2253 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
2254 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
2255 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
2256 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
2257 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
2258 : (ascent + descent) / 2));
2261 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
2262 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
2264 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2265 right = left + width;
2266 top = btm + descent + ascent;
2267 if (left < leftmost)
2268 leftmost = left;
2269 if (right > rightmost)
2270 rightmost = right;
2271 if (top > highest)
2272 highest = top;
2273 if (btm < lowest)
2274 lowest = btm;
2277 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
2278 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
2279 non-negative. */
2280 if (leftmost < 0)
2282 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2283 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
2284 rightmost -= leftmost;
2287 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
2288 cmp->ascent = highest;
2289 cmp->descent = - lowest;
2290 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
2291 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
2292 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
2293 cmp->descent = font_descent;
2296 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
2297 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
2298 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
2300 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2302 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2304 if (thick > 0)
2306 it->ascent += thick;
2307 it->descent += thick;
2309 else
2310 thick = - thick;
2312 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2313 it->pixel_width += thick;
2314 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2315 it->pixel_width += thick;
2318 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2319 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2320 if (face->overline_p)
2321 it->ascent += 2;
2323 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2325 if (it->glyph_row)
2326 x_append_composite_glyph (it);
2328 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
2329 x_produce_image_glyph (it);
2330 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
2331 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it);
2333 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
2334 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
2335 xassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
2336 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
2337 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
2339 it->descent += it->extra_line_spacing;
2341 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
2342 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
2343 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
2344 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
2348 /* Estimate the pixel height of the mode or top line on frame F.
2349 FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
2352 x_estimate_mode_line_height (f, face_id)
2353 struct frame *f;
2354 enum face_id face_id;
2356 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
2358 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
2359 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
2360 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
2362 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
2363 if (face)
2365 if (face->font)
2366 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
2367 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
2368 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
2372 return height;
2376 /***********************************************************************
2377 Glyph display
2378 ***********************************************************************/
2380 /* A sequence of glyphs to be drawn in the same face.
2382 This data structure is not really completely X specific, so it
2383 could possibly, at least partially, be useful for other systems. It
2384 is currently not part of the external redisplay interface because
2385 it's not clear what other systems will need. */
2387 struct glyph_string
2389 /* X-origin of the string. */
2390 int x;
2392 /* Y-origin and y-position of the base line of this string. */
2393 int y, ybase;
2395 /* The width of the string, not including a face extension. */
2396 int width;
2398 /* The width of the string, including a face extension. */
2399 int background_width;
2401 /* The height of this string. This is the height of the line this
2402 string is drawn in, and can be different from the height of the
2403 font the string is drawn in. */
2404 int height;
2406 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites in front of its x-origin.
2407 This number is zero if the string has an lbearing >= 0; it is
2408 -lbearing, if the string has an lbearing < 0. */
2409 int left_overhang;
2411 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites past its right-most
2412 nominal x-position, i.e. x + width. Zero if the string's
2413 rbearing is <= its nominal width, rbearing - width otherwise. */
2414 int right_overhang;
2416 /* The frame on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2417 struct frame *f;
2419 /* The window on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2420 struct window *w;
2422 /* X display and window for convenience. */
2423 Display *display;
2424 Window window;
2426 /* The glyph row for which this string was built. It determines the
2427 y-origin and height of the string. */
2428 struct glyph_row *row;
2430 /* The area within row. */
2431 enum glyph_row_area area;
2433 /* Characters to be drawn, and number of characters. */
2434 XChar2b *char2b;
2435 int nchars;
2437 /* A face-override for drawing cursors, mouse face and similar. */
2438 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
2440 /* Face in which this string is to be drawn. */
2441 struct face *face;
2443 /* Font in which this string is to be drawn. */
2444 XFontStruct *font;
2446 /* Font info for this string. */
2447 struct font_info *font_info;
2449 /* Non-null means this string describes (part of) a composition.
2450 All characters from char2b are drawn composed. */
2451 struct composition *cmp;
2453 /* Index of this glyph string's first character in the glyph
2454 definition of CMP. If this is zero, this glyph string describes
2455 the first character of a composition. */
2456 int gidx;
2458 /* 1 means this glyph strings face has to be drawn to the right end
2459 of the window's drawing area. */
2460 unsigned extends_to_end_of_line_p : 1;
2462 /* 1 means the background of this string has been drawn. */
2463 unsigned background_filled_p : 1;
2465 /* 1 means glyph string must be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
2466 unsigned two_byte_p : 1;
2468 /* 1 means that the original font determined for drawing this glyph
2469 string could not be loaded. The member `font' has been set to
2470 the frame's default font in this case. */
2471 unsigned font_not_found_p : 1;
2473 /* 1 means that the face in which this glyph string is drawn has a
2474 stipple pattern. */
2475 unsigned stippled_p : 1;
2477 /* 1 means only the foreground of this glyph string must be drawn,
2478 and we should use the physical height of the line this glyph
2479 string appears in as clip rect. */
2480 unsigned for_overlaps_p : 1;
2482 /* The GC to use for drawing this glyph string. */
2483 GC gc;
2485 /* A pointer to the first glyph in the string. This glyph
2486 corresponds to char2b[0]. Needed to draw rectangles if
2487 font_not_found_p is 1. */
2488 struct glyph *first_glyph;
2490 /* Image, if any. */
2491 struct image *img;
2493 struct glyph_string *next, *prev;
2497 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
2499 static void
2500 x_dump_glyph_string (s)
2501 struct glyph_string *s;
2503 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
2504 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
2505 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
2506 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
2507 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
2508 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
2509 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
2510 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
2511 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
2512 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
2513 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
2514 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
2517 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
2521 static void x_append_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2522 struct glyph_string **,
2523 struct glyph_string *,
2524 struct glyph_string *));
2525 static void x_prepend_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2526 struct glyph_string **,
2527 struct glyph_string *,
2528 struct glyph_string *));
2529 static void x_append_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
2530 struct glyph_string **,
2531 struct glyph_string *));
2532 static int x_left_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2533 static int x_left_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2534 static int x_right_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2535 static int x_right_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2536 static int x_fill_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int,
2537 int));
2538 static void x_init_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2539 XChar2b *, struct window *,
2540 struct glyph_row *,
2541 enum glyph_row_area, int,
2542 enum draw_glyphs_face));
2543 static int x_draw_glyphs P_ ((struct window *, int , struct glyph_row *,
2544 enum glyph_row_area, int, int,
2545 enum draw_glyphs_face, int));
2546 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2547 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2548 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2549 int));
2550 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2551 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2552 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2553 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2554 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2555 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2556 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2557 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2558 static void x_get_glyph_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph *, struct frame *,
2559 int *, int *));
2560 static void x_compute_overhangs_and_x P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int));
2561 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
2562 unsigned long *, double, int));
2563 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
2564 double, int, unsigned long));
2565 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2566 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2567 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2568 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2569 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
2570 static void x_fill_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
2571 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
2572 int, int, int));
2573 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
2574 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2575 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
2576 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
2577 static void x_fix_overlapping_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
2578 enum glyph_row_area));
2579 static int x_fill_stretch_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
2580 struct glyph_row *,
2581 enum glyph_row_area, int, int));
2583 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
2584 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
2585 #endif
2588 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
2589 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
2591 static INLINE void
2592 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2593 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2594 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2596 if (h)
2598 if (*head)
2599 (*tail)->next = h;
2600 else
2601 *head = h;
2602 h->prev = *tail;
2603 *tail = t;
2608 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
2609 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
2610 result. */
2612 static INLINE void
2613 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
2614 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2615 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
2617 if (h)
2619 if (*head)
2620 (*head)->prev = t;
2621 else
2622 *tail = t;
2623 t->next = *head;
2624 *head = h;
2629 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
2630 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
2632 static INLINE void
2633 x_append_glyph_string (head, tail, s)
2634 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
2635 struct glyph_string *s;
2637 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
2638 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
2642 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
2643 face. */
2645 static void
2646 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
2647 struct glyph_string *s;
2649 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
2650 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2651 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
2652 && !s->cmp)
2653 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
2654 else
2656 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
2657 XGCValues xgcv;
2658 unsigned long mask;
2660 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
2661 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2663 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
2664 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2665 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2666 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2667 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
2668 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
2669 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2671 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
2672 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
2673 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
2675 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
2676 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
2679 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2680 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2681 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2682 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2684 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2685 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2686 mask, &xgcv);
2687 else
2688 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2689 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2691 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2696 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
2698 static void
2699 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
2700 struct glyph_string *s;
2702 int face_id;
2703 struct face *face;
2705 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
2706 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
2707 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2708 if (face == NULL)
2709 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
2711 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2712 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
2713 else
2714 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
2715 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
2716 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2718 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
2719 if (s->font == s->face->font)
2720 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2721 else
2723 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
2724 but font FONT. */
2725 XGCValues xgcv;
2726 unsigned long mask;
2728 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
2729 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
2730 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
2731 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
2732 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2733 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
2735 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
2736 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
2737 mask, &xgcv);
2738 else
2739 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
2740 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
2742 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
2745 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2749 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
2750 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
2751 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
2753 static INLINE void
2754 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
2755 struct glyph_string *s;
2757 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2761 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
2762 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
2763 pattern. */
2765 static INLINE void
2766 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
2767 struct glyph_string *s;
2769 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
2771 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
2773 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2774 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2776 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
2778 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
2779 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2781 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2783 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
2784 s->stippled_p = 0;
2786 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
2788 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2789 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2791 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2792 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2794 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2795 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2797 else
2799 s->gc = s->face->gc;
2800 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2803 /* GC must have been set. */
2804 xassert (s->gc != 0);
2808 /* Return in *R the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2810 static void
2811 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, r)
2812 struct glyph_string *s;
2813 XRectangle *r;
2815 if (s->row->full_width_p)
2817 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left. */
2818 int canon_x = CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
2820 r->x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (s->w) * canon_x;
2821 r->width = XFASTINT (s->w->width) * canon_x;
2823 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (s->f))
2825 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * canon_x;
2826 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (s->f))
2827 r->x -= width;
2830 r->x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (s->f);
2832 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
2833 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
2834 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2835 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2836 else
2837 r->height = s->height;
2839 else
2841 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
2842 r->x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->area, 0);
2843 r->width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
2844 r->height = s->row->visible_height;
2847 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2848 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2849 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2850 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2852 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2853 r->height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r->y;
2855 else
2857 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2858 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2859 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2860 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2861 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2862 r->y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2863 else
2864 r->y = max (0, s->row->y);
2866 /* If drawing a tool-bar window, draw it over the internal border
2867 at the top of the window. */
2868 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
2869 r->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
2872 r->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r->y);
2876 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
2877 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
2879 static INLINE void
2880 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
2881 struct glyph_string *s;
2883 XRectangle r;
2884 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2885 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2889 /* Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
2890 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
2892 static INLINE void
2893 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
2894 struct glyph_string *s;
2896 if (s->cmp == NULL
2897 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2899 XCharStruct cs;
2900 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
2901 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
2902 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
2903 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
2904 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
2909 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
2910 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
2911 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
2913 static void
2914 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (s, x, backward_p)
2915 struct glyph_string *s;
2916 int x;
2917 int backward_p;
2919 if (backward_p)
2921 while (s)
2923 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2924 x -= s->width;
2925 s->x = x;
2926 s = s->prev;
2929 else
2931 while (s)
2933 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
2934 s->x = x;
2935 x += s->width;
2936 s = s->next;
2942 /* Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
2943 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
2944 assumed to be zero. */
2946 static void
2947 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, f, left, right)
2948 struct glyph *glyph;
2949 struct frame *f;
2950 int *left, *right;
2952 *left = *right = 0;
2954 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2956 XFontStruct *font;
2957 struct face *face;
2958 struct font_info *font_info;
2959 XChar2b char2b;
2960 XCharStruct *pcm;
2962 face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
2963 font = face->font;
2964 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
2965 if (font
2966 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
2968 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
2969 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
2970 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
2971 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
2977 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
2978 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
2979 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
2981 static int
2982 x_left_overwritten (s)
2983 struct glyph_string *s;
2985 int k;
2987 if (s->left_overhang)
2989 int x = 0, i;
2990 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
2991 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
2993 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
2994 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
2996 k = i + 1;
2998 else
2999 k = -1;
3001 return k;
3005 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
3006 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
3007 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
3009 static int
3010 x_left_overwriting (s)
3011 struct glyph_string *s;
3013 int i, k, x;
3014 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3015 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
3017 k = -1;
3018 x = 0;
3019 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3021 int left, right;
3022 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3023 if (x + right > 0)
3024 k = i;
3025 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3028 return k;
3032 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
3033 not overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
3034 no such glyph is found. */
3036 static int
3037 x_right_overwritten (s)
3038 struct glyph_string *s;
3040 int k = -1;
3042 if (s->right_overhang)
3044 int x = 0, i;
3045 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3046 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3047 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3049 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
3050 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3052 k = i;
3055 return k;
3059 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
3060 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
3061 if no such glyph is found. */
3063 static int
3064 x_right_overwriting (s)
3065 struct glyph_string *s;
3067 int i, k, x;
3068 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3069 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3070 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3072 k = -1;
3073 x = 0;
3074 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
3076 int left, right;
3077 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3078 if (x - left < 0)
3079 k = i;
3080 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3083 return k;
3087 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
3089 static INLINE void
3090 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
3091 struct glyph_string *s;
3092 int x, y, w, h;
3094 XGCValues xgcv;
3095 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
3096 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
3097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
3098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3102 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
3103 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
3104 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
3105 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
3106 contains the first component of a composition. */
3108 static void
3109 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
3110 struct glyph_string *s;
3111 int force_p;
3113 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
3114 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
3115 if (!s->background_filled_p)
3117 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
3119 if (s->stippled_p)
3121 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3122 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3123 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
3124 s->y + box_line_width,
3125 s->background_width,
3126 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
3127 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
3128 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3130 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
3131 || s->font_not_found_p
3132 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
3133 || force_p)
3135 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
3136 s->background_width,
3137 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
3138 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3144 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
3146 static void
3147 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3148 struct glyph_string *s;
3150 int i, x;
3152 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3153 of S to the right of that box line. */
3154 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3155 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3156 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
3157 else
3158 x = s->x;
3160 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
3161 loaded. */
3162 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3164 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3166 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
3167 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
3168 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
3169 s->height - 1);
3170 x += g->pixel_width;
3173 else
3175 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
3176 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
3178 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
3179 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
3181 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
3182 if (!s->two_byte_p)
3183 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3184 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
3186 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
3187 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
3188 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
3189 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
3190 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
3191 if (s->for_overlaps_p
3192 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
3194 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
3195 if (s->two_byte_p)
3196 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3197 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3198 else
3199 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3200 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3202 else
3204 if (s->two_byte_p)
3205 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3206 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3207 else
3208 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3209 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3214 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
3216 static void
3217 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3218 struct glyph_string *s;
3220 int i, x;
3222 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3223 of S to the right of that box line. */
3224 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3225 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3226 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
3227 else
3228 x = s->x;
3230 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
3231 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
3232 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
3233 this composition. */
3235 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
3236 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
3237 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3239 if (s->gidx == 0)
3240 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
3241 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
3243 else
3245 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
3246 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3247 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
3248 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
3249 s->char2b + i, 1);
3254 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3256 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
3257 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
3258 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
3259 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
3260 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
3263 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
3264 cannot be determined. */
3266 static struct frame *
3267 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
3268 Widget widget;
3270 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3271 Lisp_Object tail;
3272 struct frame *f;
3274 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
3276 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
3277 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
3278 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
3279 x_any_window_to_frame. */
3280 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
3281 widget = XtParent (widget);
3283 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
3284 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
3285 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3286 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
3287 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
3288 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
3289 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
3290 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
3291 return f;
3293 abort ();
3297 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
3298 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
3299 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
3300 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
3303 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
3304 Widget widget;
3305 Colormap cmap;
3306 XColor *color;
3308 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3309 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
3313 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3314 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3315 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3316 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3317 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3318 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3321 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3322 Widget widget;
3323 Display *display;
3324 Colormap cmap;
3325 unsigned long *pixel;
3326 double factor;
3327 int delta;
3329 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3330 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
3334 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
3335 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
3337 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
3339 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
3340 sizeof (Screen *)},
3341 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
3342 sizeof (Colormap)}
3346 /* The address of this variable is returned by
3347 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
3349 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
3352 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
3354 DPY is the display we are working on.
3356 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
3357 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
3358 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
3359 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
3361 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
3362 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
3364 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
3365 we allocated the color or not.
3367 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
3369 static Boolean
3370 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
3371 Display *dpy;
3372 XrmValue *args;
3373 Cardinal *nargs;
3374 XrmValue *from, *to;
3375 XtPointer *closure_ret;
3377 Screen *screen;
3378 Colormap cmap;
3379 Pixel pixel;
3380 String color_name;
3381 XColor color;
3383 if (*nargs != 2)
3385 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
3386 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
3387 "XtToolkitError",
3388 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
3389 return False;
3392 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
3393 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
3394 color_name = (String) from->addr;
3396 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
3398 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
3399 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
3401 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
3403 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
3404 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
3406 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
3407 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
3409 pixel = color.pixel;
3410 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
3412 else
3414 String params[1];
3415 Cardinal nparams = 1;
3417 params[0] = color_name;
3418 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
3419 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
3420 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
3421 params, &nparams);
3422 return False;
3425 if (to->addr != NULL)
3427 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
3429 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
3430 return False;
3433 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
3435 else
3437 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
3438 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
3441 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
3442 return True;
3446 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
3447 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
3448 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
3450 APP is the application context in which we work.
3452 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
3453 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
3454 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
3456 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
3458 static void
3459 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
3460 XtAppContext app;
3461 XrmValuePtr to;
3462 XtPointer closure;
3463 XrmValuePtr args;
3464 Cardinal *nargs;
3466 if (*nargs != 2)
3468 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
3469 "XtToolkitError",
3470 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
3471 NULL, NULL);
3473 else if (closure != NULL)
3475 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
3476 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
3477 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
3478 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
3479 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
3484 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3487 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
3488 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
3489 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
3490 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
3492 static const XColor *
3493 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
3494 Display *dpy;
3495 int *ncells;
3497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
3499 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
3501 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
3502 int i;
3504 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3505 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
3506 dpyinfo->color_cells
3507 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
3508 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
3510 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
3511 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
3513 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
3514 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3517 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
3518 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
3522 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
3523 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
3525 void
3526 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
3527 struct frame *f;
3528 XColor *colors;
3529 int ncolors;
3531 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3533 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
3535 int i;
3536 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
3538 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
3539 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
3540 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
3541 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
3544 else
3545 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
3549 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
3550 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
3552 void
3553 x_query_color (f, color)
3554 struct frame *f;
3555 XColor *color;
3557 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
3561 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
3562 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
3563 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
3564 allocated. */
3566 static int
3567 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
3568 Display *dpy;
3569 Colormap cmap;
3570 XColor *color;
3572 int rc;
3574 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
3575 if (rc == 0)
3577 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
3578 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
3579 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
3580 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
3581 int nearest, i;
3582 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
3583 int ncells;
3584 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
3586 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
3588 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
3589 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
3590 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
3591 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
3593 if (delta < nearest_delta)
3595 nearest = i;
3596 nearest_delta = delta;
3600 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
3601 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
3602 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
3603 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
3605 else
3607 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
3608 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
3609 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
3610 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
3611 XColor *cached_color;
3613 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
3614 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
3615 (cached_color->red != color->red
3616 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
3617 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
3619 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
3620 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
3621 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
3625 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3626 if (rc)
3627 register_color (color->pixel);
3628 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
3630 return rc;
3634 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
3635 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
3636 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
3637 allocated. */
3640 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
3641 struct frame *f;
3642 Colormap cmap;
3643 XColor *color;
3645 gamma_correct (f, color);
3646 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
3650 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3651 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3652 get color reference counts right. */
3654 unsigned long
3655 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
3656 struct frame *f;
3657 unsigned long pixel;
3659 XColor color;
3661 color.pixel = pixel;
3662 BLOCK_INPUT;
3663 x_query_color (f, &color);
3664 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
3665 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3666 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3667 register_color (pixel);
3668 #endif
3669 return color.pixel;
3673 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3674 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3675 get color reference counts right. */
3677 unsigned long
3678 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
3679 Display *dpy;
3680 Colormap cmap;
3681 unsigned long pixel;
3683 XColor color;
3685 color.pixel = pixel;
3686 BLOCK_INPUT;
3687 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3688 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3690 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3691 register_color (pixel);
3692 #endif
3693 return color.pixel;
3697 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
3698 boosted.
3700 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
3701 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
3702 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
3703 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
3704 use an additional additive factor.
3706 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
3707 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
3708 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
3711 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
3712 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3713 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
3714 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
3715 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3716 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3718 static int
3719 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
3720 struct frame *f;
3721 Display *display;
3722 Colormap cmap;
3723 unsigned long *pixel;
3724 double factor;
3725 int delta;
3727 XColor color, new;
3728 long bright;
3729 int success_p;
3731 /* Get RGB color values. */
3732 color.pixel = *pixel;
3733 x_query_color (f, &color);
3735 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
3736 xassert (factor >= 0);
3737 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
3738 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
3739 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
3741 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
3742 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
3744 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
3745 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
3746 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
3747 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
3748 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
3750 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
3751 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
3752 /* The additive adjustment. */
3753 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
3755 if (factor < 1)
3757 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
3758 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
3759 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
3761 else
3763 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
3764 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
3765 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
3769 /* Try to allocate the color. */
3770 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3771 if (success_p)
3773 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
3775 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
3776 delta to the RGB values. */
3777 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
3779 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
3780 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
3781 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
3782 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
3784 else
3785 success_p = 1;
3786 *pixel = new.pixel;
3789 return success_p;
3793 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
3794 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
3795 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
3796 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
3797 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
3798 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
3800 static void
3801 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
3802 struct frame *f;
3803 struct relief *relief;
3804 double factor;
3805 int delta;
3806 unsigned long default_pixel;
3808 XGCValues xgcv;
3809 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
3810 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
3811 unsigned long pixel;
3812 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
3813 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
3814 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3815 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3817 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
3818 xgcv.line_width = 1;
3820 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
3821 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
3822 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
3823 if (relief->gc
3824 && relief->allocated_p)
3826 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
3827 relief->allocated_p = 0;
3830 /* Allocate new color. */
3831 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
3832 pixel = background;
3833 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
3834 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
3836 relief->allocated_p = 1;
3837 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
3840 if (relief->gc == 0)
3842 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
3843 mask |= GCStipple;
3844 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
3846 else
3847 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3851 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
3853 static void
3854 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
3855 struct glyph_string *s;
3857 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
3858 unsigned long color;
3860 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
3861 color = s->face->box_color;
3862 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
3863 && s->img->pixmap
3864 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
3865 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
3866 else
3868 XGCValues xgcv;
3870 /* Get the background color of the face. */
3871 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
3872 color = xgcv.background;
3875 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
3876 || color != di->relief_background)
3878 di->relief_background = color;
3879 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
3880 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3881 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
3882 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
3887 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
3888 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
3889 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
3890 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
3891 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
3892 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
3893 when drawing. */
3895 static void
3896 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3897 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
3898 struct frame *f;
3899 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
3900 XRectangle *clip_rect;
3902 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3903 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
3904 int i;
3905 GC gc;
3907 if (raised_p)
3908 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3909 else
3910 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3911 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3913 /* Top. */
3914 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3915 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3916 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
3917 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
3919 /* Left. */
3920 if (left_p)
3921 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3922 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3923 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
3925 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
3926 if (raised_p)
3927 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
3928 else
3929 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
3930 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3932 /* Bottom. */
3933 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3934 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3935 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
3936 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
3938 /* Right. */
3939 if (right_p)
3940 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
3941 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
3942 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
3944 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
3948 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
3949 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
3950 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
3951 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
3952 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
3953 rectangle to use when drawing. */
3955 static void
3956 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
3957 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
3958 struct glyph_string *s;
3959 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p;
3960 XRectangle *clip_rect;
3962 XGCValues xgcv;
3964 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3965 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
3966 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
3968 /* Top. */
3969 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3970 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
3972 /* Left. */
3973 if (left_p)
3974 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3975 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
3977 /* Bottom. */
3978 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3979 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
3981 /* Right. */
3982 if (right_p)
3983 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3984 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
3986 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3987 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3991 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
3993 static void
3994 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
3995 struct glyph_string *s;
3997 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
3998 int left_p, right_p;
3999 struct glyph *last_glyph;
4000 XRectangle clip_rect;
4002 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
4003 if (s->row->full_width_p
4004 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
4006 last_x += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->f);
4007 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (s->f))
4008 last_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
4011 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
4012 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
4013 ? s->first_glyph
4014 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
4016 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4017 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
4018 left_x = s->x;
4019 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
4020 ? last_x - 1
4021 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
4022 top_y = s->y;
4023 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
4025 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
4026 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4027 && (s->prev == NULL
4028 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
4029 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
4030 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4031 && (s->next == NULL
4032 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
4034 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4036 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
4037 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
4038 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4039 else
4041 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4042 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
4043 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4048 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
4050 static void
4051 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
4052 struct glyph_string *s;
4054 int x;
4055 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4057 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4058 right of that line. */
4059 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4060 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4061 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4062 else
4063 x = s->x;
4065 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4066 by that margin. */
4067 x += s->img->hmargin;
4068 y += s->img->vmargin;
4070 if (s->img->pixmap)
4072 if (s->img->mask)
4074 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4075 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4076 trust on the shape extension to be available
4077 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4078 manually. */
4079 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4080 | GCFunction);
4081 XGCValues xgcv;
4082 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
4084 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4085 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4086 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4087 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4088 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4090 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4091 image_rect.x = x;
4092 image_rect.y = y;
4093 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
4094 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
4095 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
4096 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4097 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
4099 else
4101 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
4103 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4104 image_rect.x = x;
4105 image_rect.y = y;
4106 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
4107 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
4108 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
4109 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4110 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
4112 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4113 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4114 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4115 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4116 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4117 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4118 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4119 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
4120 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4123 else
4124 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4125 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
4126 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4130 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
4132 static void
4133 x_draw_image_relief (s)
4134 struct glyph_string *s;
4136 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
4137 XRectangle r;
4138 int x;
4139 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4141 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4142 right of that line. */
4143 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4144 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4145 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4146 else
4147 x = s->x;
4149 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4150 by that margin. */
4151 x += s->img->hmargin;
4152 y += s->img->vmargin;
4154 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
4155 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
4157 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
4158 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
4160 else
4162 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
4163 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
4166 x0 = x - thick;
4167 y0 = y - thick;
4168 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
4169 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
4171 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4172 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4173 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
4177 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
4179 static void
4180 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
4181 struct glyph_string *s;
4182 Pixmap pixmap;
4184 int x;
4185 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4187 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4188 right of that line. */
4189 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4190 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4191 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4192 else
4193 x = 0;
4195 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4196 by that margin. */
4197 x += s->img->hmargin;
4198 y += s->img->vmargin;
4200 if (s->img->pixmap)
4202 if (s->img->mask)
4204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4206 trust on the shape extension to be available
4207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4208 manually. */
4209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4210 | GCFunction);
4211 XGCValues xgcv;
4213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4219 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4220 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4221 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4223 else
4225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4226 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4228 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4229 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4230 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4231 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4232 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4233 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4234 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4235 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
4236 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4239 else
4240 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4241 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
4242 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4246 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
4247 give the rectangle to draw. */
4249 static void
4250 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
4251 struct glyph_string *s;
4252 int x, y, w, h;
4254 if (s->stippled_p)
4256 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4257 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4258 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
4259 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4261 else
4262 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
4266 /* Draw image glyph string S.
4268 s->y
4269 s->x +-------------------------
4270 | s->face->box
4272 | +-------------------------
4273 | | s->img->margin
4275 | | +-------------------
4276 | | | the image
4280 static void
4281 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
4282 struct glyph_string *s;
4284 int x, y;
4285 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
4286 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
4287 int height;
4288 Pixmap pixmap = None;
4290 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
4292 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
4293 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
4294 flickering. */
4295 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4296 if (height > s->img->height
4297 || s->img->hmargin
4298 || s->img->vmargin
4299 || s->img->mask
4300 || s->img->pixmap == 0
4301 || s->width != s->background_width)
4303 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4304 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
4305 else
4306 x = s->x;
4308 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
4310 if (s->img->mask)
4312 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
4313 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
4314 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
4315 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
4316 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
4318 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
4319 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
4320 s->background_width,
4321 s->height, depth);
4323 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
4324 pixmap. */
4325 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4327 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
4328 if (s->stippled_p)
4330 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4331 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4332 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4333 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4334 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4336 else
4338 XGCValues xgcv;
4339 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
4340 &xgcv);
4341 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
4342 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4343 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4344 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4347 else
4348 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
4350 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4353 /* Draw the foreground. */
4354 if (pixmap != None)
4356 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
4357 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4358 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4359 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
4360 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
4362 else
4363 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
4365 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
4366 if (s->img->relief
4367 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
4368 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4369 x_draw_image_relief (s);
4373 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
4375 static void
4376 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
4377 struct glyph_string *s;
4379 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4380 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4382 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
4383 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
4385 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
4386 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
4387 int width = min (CANON_X_UNIT (s->f), s->background_width);
4389 /* Draw cursor. */
4390 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
4392 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
4393 if (width < s->background_width)
4395 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
4396 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
4397 XRectangle r;
4398 GC gc;
4400 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
4401 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
4403 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
4404 gc = s->gc;
4406 else
4407 gc = s->face->gc;
4409 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4410 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
4412 if (s->face->stipple)
4414 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4415 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4416 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4417 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
4419 else
4421 XGCValues xgcv;
4422 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
4423 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
4424 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4425 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
4429 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
4430 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
4431 s->height);
4433 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4437 /* Draw glyph string S. */
4439 static void
4440 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
4441 struct glyph_string *s;
4443 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
4445 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
4446 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
4447 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
4448 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
4450 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
4451 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
4452 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
4453 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
4456 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
4457 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
4459 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
4460 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
4461 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
4462 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4463 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4464 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
4467 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4468 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4469 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4470 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4471 relief_drawn_p = 1;
4473 else
4474 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4476 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
4478 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
4479 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
4480 break;
4482 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
4483 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
4484 break;
4486 case CHAR_GLYPH:
4487 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
4488 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4489 else
4490 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
4491 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4492 break;
4494 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
4495 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
4496 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4497 else
4498 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4499 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4500 break;
4502 default:
4503 abort ();
4506 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
4508 /* Draw underline. */
4509 if (s->face->underline_p)
4511 unsigned long tem, h;
4512 int y;
4514 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
4515 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
4516 h = 1;
4518 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
4519 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
4520 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
4521 specs, and its default is
4523 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
4524 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
4526 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
4527 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
4528 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
4529 else if (s->face->font)
4530 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
4531 else
4532 y = s->y + s->height - h;
4534 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
4535 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4536 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4537 else
4539 XGCValues xgcv;
4540 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4541 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
4542 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
4543 s->x, y, s->width, h);
4544 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4548 /* Draw overline. */
4549 if (s->face->overline_p)
4551 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
4553 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
4554 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4555 s->width, h);
4556 else
4558 XGCValues xgcv;
4559 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4560 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
4561 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4562 s->width, h);
4563 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4567 /* Draw strike-through. */
4568 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
4570 unsigned long h = 1;
4571 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
4573 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
4574 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4575 s->width, h);
4576 else
4578 XGCValues xgcv;
4579 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4580 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
4581 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4582 s->width, h);
4583 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4587 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
4588 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
4589 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4592 /* Reset clipping. */
4593 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4597 static int x_fill_composite_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
4598 struct face **, int));
4601 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
4603 FACES is an array of faces for all components of this composition.
4604 S->gidx is the index of the first component for S.
4605 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4606 use its physical height for clipping.
4608 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
4610 static int
4611 x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, overlaps_p)
4612 struct glyph_string *s;
4613 struct face **faces;
4614 int overlaps_p;
4616 int i;
4618 xassert (s);
4620 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p;
4622 s->face = faces[s->gidx];
4623 s->font = s->face->font;
4624 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4626 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
4627 S->gidx, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
4628 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
4629 ++s->nchars;
4630 for (i = s->gidx + 1; i < s->cmp->glyph_len && faces[i] == s->face; ++i)
4631 ++s->nchars;
4633 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
4634 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
4636 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4638 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
4639 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4640 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
4641 characters of the glyph string. */
4642 if (s->font == NULL)
4644 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4645 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4648 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4649 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4651 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4653 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
4654 s->two_byte_p = 1;
4656 return s->gidx + s->nchars;
4660 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
4662 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
4663 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4664 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4665 use its physical height for clipping.
4667 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4669 static int
4670 x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, start, end, overlaps_p)
4671 struct glyph_string *s;
4672 int face_id;
4673 int start, end, overlaps_p;
4675 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4676 int voffset;
4677 int glyph_not_available_p;
4679 xassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
4680 xassert (s->nchars == 0);
4681 xassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
4683 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p,
4684 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4685 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4686 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4688 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
4690 while (glyph < last
4691 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4692 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4693 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
4694 && glyph->face_id == face_id
4695 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
4697 int two_byte_p;
4699 s->face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
4700 s->char2b + s->nchars,
4701 &two_byte_p);
4702 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
4703 ++s->nchars;
4704 xassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
4705 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4706 ++glyph;
4709 s->font = s->face->font;
4710 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4712 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
4713 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4714 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
4715 characters of the glyph string. */
4716 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
4718 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4719 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4722 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4723 s->ybase += voffset;
4725 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4726 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4730 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
4732 static void
4733 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s)
4734 struct glyph_string *s;
4736 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
4737 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
4738 xassert (s->img);
4739 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
4740 s->font = s->face->font;
4741 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4743 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4744 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4748 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
4750 ROW is the glyph row in which the glyphs are found, AREA is the
4751 area within the row. START is the index of the first glyph to
4752 consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4754 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4756 static int
4757 x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, row, area, start, end)
4758 struct glyph_string *s;
4759 struct glyph_row *row;
4760 enum glyph_row_area area;
4761 int start, end;
4763 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4764 int voffset, face_id;
4766 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4768 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4769 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4770 face_id = glyph->face_id;
4771 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
4772 s->font = s->face->font;
4773 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4774 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
4775 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4777 for (++glyph;
4778 (glyph < last
4779 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
4780 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4781 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
4782 ++glyph)
4783 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4785 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4786 s->ybase += voffset;
4788 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
4789 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
4790 xassert (s->face);
4791 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4795 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
4796 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
4797 x_init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
4798 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
4799 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
4800 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
4801 face-override for drawing S. */
4803 static void
4804 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
4805 struct glyph_string *s;
4806 XChar2b *char2b;
4807 struct window *w;
4808 struct glyph_row *row;
4809 enum glyph_row_area area;
4810 int start;
4811 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
4813 bzero (s, sizeof *s);
4814 s->w = w;
4815 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4816 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
4817 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
4818 s->char2b = char2b;
4819 s->hl = hl;
4820 s->row = row;
4821 s->area = area;
4822 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
4823 s->height = row->height;
4824 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
4826 /* Display the internal border below the tool-bar window. */
4827 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
4828 s->y -= s->f->output_data.x->internal_border_width;
4830 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
4834 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
4835 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
4836 in the drawing area. */
4838 static INLINE void
4839 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, start, last_x)
4840 struct glyph_string *s;
4841 int start;
4842 int last_x;
4844 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
4845 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
4846 struct face *default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
4848 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
4849 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
4850 && ((s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
4851 && (s->row->fill_line_p
4852 || s->face->background != default_face->background
4853 || s->face->stipple != default_face->stipple
4854 || s->row->mouse_face_p))
4855 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4856 || ((s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4857 && s->row->fill_line_p)))
4858 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
4860 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
4861 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
4862 area. */
4863 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
4864 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
4865 else
4866 s->background_width = s->width;
4870 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
4871 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
4872 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4873 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4874 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4875 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4876 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4878 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
4879 and below -- keep them on one line. */
4880 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4881 do \
4883 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4884 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4885 START = x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, ROW, AREA, START, END); \
4886 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4887 s->x = (X); \
4889 while (0)
4892 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
4893 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
4894 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4895 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4896 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4897 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4898 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4900 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4901 do \
4903 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4904 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4905 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
4906 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4907 ++START; \
4908 s->x = (X); \
4910 while (0)
4913 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
4914 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
4915 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
4916 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
4917 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
4918 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
4919 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
4920 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4922 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4923 do \
4925 int c, face_id; \
4926 XChar2b *char2b; \
4928 c = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.ch; \
4929 face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
4931 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4932 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
4933 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4934 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4935 s->x = (X); \
4936 START = x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
4937 OVERLAPS_P); \
4939 while (0)
4942 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
4943 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
4944 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
4945 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
4946 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
4947 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
4948 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
4949 x-position of the drawing area. */
4951 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
4952 do { \
4953 int cmp_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.cmp_id; \
4954 int face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
4955 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), face_id); \
4956 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
4957 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; \
4958 XChar2b *char2b; \
4959 struct face **faces; \
4960 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
4961 int n; \
4963 base_face = base_face->ascii_face; \
4964 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((sizeof *char2b) * glyph_len); \
4965 faces = (struct face **) alloca ((sizeof *faces) * glyph_len); \
4966 /* At first, fill in `char2b' and `faces'. */ \
4967 for (n = 0; n < glyph_len; n++) \
4969 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, n); \
4970 int this_face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face, c); \
4971 faces[n] = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), this_face_id); \
4972 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (XFRAME (w->frame), c, \
4973 this_face_id, char2b + n, 1, 1); \
4976 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
4977 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
4978 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
4980 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4981 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b + n, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4982 x_append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
4983 s->cmp = cmp; \
4984 s->gidx = n; \
4985 s->x = (X); \
4987 if (n == 0) \
4988 first_s = s; \
4990 n = x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, OVERLAPS_P); \
4993 ++START; \
4994 s = first_s; \
4995 } while (0)
4998 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
4999 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
5000 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
5001 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
5002 x-positions of the drawing area.
5004 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
5005 to allocate glyph strings (because x_draw_glyphs can be called
5006 asynchronously). */
5008 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
5009 do \
5011 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
5012 while (START < END) \
5014 struct glyph *first_glyph = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA] + START; \
5015 switch (first_glyph->type) \
5017 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
5018 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5019 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, \
5020 OVERLAPS_P); \
5021 break; \
5023 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
5024 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5025 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X,\
5026 OVERLAPS_P); \
5027 break; \
5029 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
5030 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5031 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5032 break; \
5034 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
5035 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5036 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5037 break; \
5039 default: \
5040 abort (); \
5043 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
5044 (X) += s->width; \
5047 while (0)
5050 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
5051 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
5052 face-override with the following meaning:
5054 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
5055 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
5056 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
5057 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
5058 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
5059 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
5061 If OVERLAPS_P is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters
5062 and clip to the physical height of ROW.
5064 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
5066 static int
5067 x_draw_glyphs (w, x, row, area, start, end, hl, overlaps_p)
5068 struct window *w;
5069 int x;
5070 struct glyph_row *row;
5071 enum glyph_row_area area;
5072 int start, end;
5073 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
5074 int overlaps_p;
5076 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
5077 struct glyph_string *s;
5078 int last_x, area_width;
5079 int x_reached;
5080 int i, j;
5082 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
5083 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
5084 start = max (0, start);
5085 start = min (end, start);
5087 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
5088 end of the drawing area. */
5089 if (row->full_width_p)
5091 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
5092 or fringes. */
5093 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5094 int window_left_x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (w) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5096 x += window_left_x;
5097 area_width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5098 last_x = window_left_x + area_width;
5100 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5102 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5103 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
5104 last_x += width;
5105 else
5106 x -= width;
5109 x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5110 last_x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5112 else
5114 x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, x);
5115 area_width = window_box_width (w, area);
5116 last_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, area_width);
5119 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
5120 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
5121 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
5122 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
5123 i = start;
5124 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x,
5125 overlaps_p);
5126 if (tail)
5127 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
5128 else
5129 x_reached = x;
5131 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
5132 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
5133 strings built above. */
5134 if (head && !overlaps_p && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
5136 int dummy_x = 0;
5137 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
5139 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
5140 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5141 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
5143 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5144 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
5145 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
5146 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
5147 draws over it. */
5148 i = x_left_overwritten (head);
5149 if (i >= 0)
5151 j = i;
5152 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, j, start, h, t,
5153 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5154 overlaps_p);
5155 start = i;
5156 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5157 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5160 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5161 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
5162 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
5163 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
5164 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
5165 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
5166 strings exist. */
5167 i = x_left_overwriting (head);
5168 if (i >= 0)
5170 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, start, h, t,
5171 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5172 overlaps_p);
5173 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5174 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5175 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5176 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5179 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5180 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
5181 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
5182 over it. */
5183 i = x_right_overwritten (tail);
5184 if (i >= 0)
5186 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5187 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5188 overlaps_p);
5189 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5190 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5193 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5194 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
5195 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
5196 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
5197 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
5198 i = x_right_overwriting (tail);
5199 if (i >= 0)
5201 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5202 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5203 overlaps_p);
5204 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5205 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5206 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5207 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5211 /* Draw all strings. */
5212 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5213 x_draw_glyph_string (s);
5215 if (area == TEXT_AREA
5216 && !row->full_width_p
5217 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
5218 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
5219 completely. */
5220 && !overlaps_p)
5222 int x0 = head ? head->x : x;
5223 int x1 = tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x;
5225 x0 = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x0);
5226 x1 = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x1);
5228 if (XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) != 0)
5230 int left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5231 x0 -= left_area_width;
5232 x1 -= left_area_width;
5235 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, area, x0, x1,
5236 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
5239 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
5240 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
5241 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
5242 if (!row->full_width_p)
5244 if (area > LEFT_MARGIN_AREA && XFASTINT (w->left_margin_width) != 0)
5245 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5246 if (area > TEXT_AREA)
5247 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
5250 return x_reached;
5254 /* Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W. */
5256 static void
5257 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, area)
5258 struct window *w;
5259 struct glyph_row *row;
5260 enum glyph_row_area area;
5262 int i, x;
5264 BLOCK_INPUT;
5266 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5267 x = 0;
5268 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5269 x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5270 else
5271 x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5272 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5274 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
5276 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
5278 int start = i, start_x = x;
5282 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5283 ++i;
5285 while (i < row->used[area]
5286 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
5288 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area, start, i,
5289 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 1);
5291 else
5293 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5294 ++i;
5298 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5302 /* Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
5303 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
5304 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
5305 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
5306 row being updated. */
5308 static void
5309 x_write_glyphs (start, len)
5310 struct glyph *start;
5311 int len;
5313 int x, hpos;
5315 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5316 BLOCK_INPUT;
5318 /* Write glyphs. */
5320 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
5321 x = x_draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
5322 updated_row, updated_area,
5323 hpos, hpos + len,
5324 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5326 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5328 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5329 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5330 output_cursor.x = x;
5334 /* Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
5336 static void
5337 x_insert_glyphs (start, len)
5338 struct glyph *start;
5339 register int len;
5341 struct frame *f;
5342 struct window *w;
5343 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
5344 struct glyph_row *row;
5345 struct glyph *glyph;
5346 int frame_x, frame_y, hpos;
5348 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5349 BLOCK_INPUT;
5350 w = updated_window;
5351 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
5353 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
5354 row = updated_row;
5355 line_height = row->height;
5357 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
5358 shift_by_width = 0;
5359 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
5360 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
5362 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
5363 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
5364 - output_cursor.x
5365 - shift_by_width);
5367 /* Shift right. */
5368 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
5369 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
5370 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5371 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5372 frame_x, frame_y,
5373 shifted_region_width, line_height,
5374 frame_x + shift_by_width, frame_y);
5376 /* Write the glyphs. */
5377 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
5378 x_draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area, hpos, hpos + len,
5379 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5381 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5382 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5383 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
5384 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5388 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
5389 for X frames. */
5391 static void
5392 x_delete_glyphs (n)
5393 register int n;
5395 abort ();
5399 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
5400 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
5402 void
5403 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
5404 Display *dpy;
5405 Window window;
5406 int x, y;
5407 int width, height;
5408 int exposures;
5410 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
5411 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
5415 /* Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
5416 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
5417 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
5419 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
5420 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
5422 static void
5423 x_clear_end_of_line (to_x)
5424 int to_x;
5426 struct frame *f;
5427 struct window *w = updated_window;
5428 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
5429 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
5431 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5432 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5434 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5436 max_x = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5437 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
5438 && !w->pseudo_window_p)
5439 max_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5441 else
5442 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
5443 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
5445 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
5446 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
5447 if (to_x == 0)
5448 return;
5449 else if (to_x < 0)
5450 to_x = max_x;
5451 else
5452 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
5454 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
5456 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
5457 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
5458 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
5459 output_cursor.x, -1,
5460 updated_row->y,
5461 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
5463 from_x = output_cursor.x;
5465 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
5466 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5468 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
5469 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
5471 else
5473 from_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, from_x);
5474 to_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, to_x);
5477 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
5478 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
5479 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
5481 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
5482 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
5484 BLOCK_INPUT;
5485 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5486 from_x, from_y, to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y,
5487 False);
5488 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5493 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
5494 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
5496 static void
5497 x_clear_frame ()
5499 struct frame *f;
5501 if (updating_frame)
5502 f = updating_frame;
5503 else
5504 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5506 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
5507 longer visible. */
5508 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
5509 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
5510 output_cursor.x = -1;
5512 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
5513 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
5514 BLOCK_INPUT;
5515 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
5517 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
5518 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
5519 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
5521 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5522 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5527 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
5529 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
5530 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
5532 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5535 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
5536 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
5538 static int
5539 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
5540 struct timeval *result, x, y;
5542 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
5543 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
5544 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
5546 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
5547 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
5548 y.tv_sec += nsec;
5551 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
5553 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
5554 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
5555 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
5558 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
5559 positive. */
5560 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
5561 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
5563 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
5564 negative. */
5565 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
5568 void
5569 XTflash (f)
5570 struct frame *f;
5572 BLOCK_INPUT;
5575 GC gc;
5577 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
5578 pixels into background pixels. */
5580 XGCValues values;
5582 values.function = GXxor;
5583 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
5584 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
5586 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5587 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
5591 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
5592 int height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_HEIGHT (f));
5593 /* Height of each line to flash. */
5594 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
5595 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
5596 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5597 int flash_right = PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5599 int width;
5601 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
5602 edge it is next to. */
5603 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
5605 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
5606 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5607 break;
5609 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
5610 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5611 break;
5613 default:
5614 break;
5617 width = flash_right - flash_left;
5619 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5620 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5622 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5623 flash_left,
5624 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5625 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5626 width, flash_height);
5627 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5628 flash_left,
5629 (height - flash_height
5630 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5631 width, flash_height);
5633 else
5634 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5635 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5636 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5637 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5639 x_flush (f);
5642 struct timeval wakeup;
5644 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
5646 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
5647 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
5648 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
5649 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
5651 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
5652 available. */
5653 while (! detect_input_pending ())
5655 struct timeval current;
5656 struct timeval timeout;
5658 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
5660 /* Break if result would be negative. */
5661 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
5662 break;
5664 /* How long `select' should wait. */
5665 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
5666 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
5668 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
5669 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
5673 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
5674 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
5676 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5677 flash_left,
5678 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
5679 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f)),
5680 width, flash_height);
5681 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5682 flash_left,
5683 (height - flash_height
5684 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
5685 width, flash_height);
5687 else
5688 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
5689 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
5690 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
5691 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
5693 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
5694 x_flush (f);
5698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5701 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
5704 /* Make audible bell. */
5706 void
5707 XTring_bell ()
5709 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5711 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
5713 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5714 if (visible_bell)
5715 XTflash (f);
5716 else
5717 #endif
5719 BLOCK_INPUT;
5720 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
5721 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
5722 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5728 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
5729 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
5730 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
5731 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
5733 static void
5734 XTset_terminal_window (n)
5735 register int n;
5737 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
5742 /***********************************************************************
5743 Line Dance
5744 ***********************************************************************/
5746 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
5747 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
5749 static void
5750 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
5751 int vpos, n;
5753 abort ();
5757 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
5759 static void
5760 x_scroll_run (w, run)
5761 struct window *w;
5762 struct run *run;
5764 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5765 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
5767 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
5768 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
5769 fringe of W. */
5770 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
5771 width += FRAME_X_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
5772 x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
5774 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
5775 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
5776 bottom_y = y + height;
5778 if (to_y < from_y)
5780 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
5781 line at the bottom. */
5782 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5783 height = bottom_y - from_y;
5784 else
5785 height = run->height;
5787 else
5789 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
5790 at the bottom. */
5791 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5792 height = bottom_y - to_y;
5793 else
5794 height = run->height;
5797 BLOCK_INPUT;
5799 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
5800 updated_window = w;
5801 x_clear_cursor (w);
5803 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5804 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5805 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
5806 x, from_y,
5807 width, height,
5808 x, to_y);
5810 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5815 /***********************************************************************
5816 Exposure Events
5817 ***********************************************************************/
5819 /* Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
5820 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
5821 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
5822 the entire frame. */
5824 static void
5825 expose_frame (f, x, y, w, h)
5826 struct frame *f;
5827 int x, y, w, h;
5829 XRectangle r;
5830 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
5832 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
5834 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
5835 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5837 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
5838 return;
5841 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
5842 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
5843 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
5844 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
5845 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
5847 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
5848 return;
5851 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
5853 r.x = r.y = 0;
5854 r.width = CANON_X_UNIT (f) * f->width;
5855 r.height = CANON_Y_UNIT (f) * f->height;
5857 else
5859 r.x = x;
5860 r.y = y;
5861 r.width = w;
5862 r.height = h;
5865 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
5866 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
5868 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
5869 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5870 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
5872 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5873 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
5874 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5875 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
5876 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5878 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
5879 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
5880 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
5881 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
5882 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
5883 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
5884 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
5885 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
5886 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
5887 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
5888 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5890 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
5891 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
5893 int x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
5894 int y = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
5895 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
5896 note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y);
5902 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
5903 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
5904 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
5906 static int
5907 expose_window_tree (w, r)
5908 struct window *w;
5909 XRectangle *r;
5911 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5912 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
5914 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5916 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
5917 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5918 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
5919 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
5920 mouse_face_overwritten_p
5921 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
5922 else
5923 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
5925 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
5928 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
5932 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
5933 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
5935 static void
5936 expose_area (w, row, r, area)
5937 struct window *w;
5938 struct glyph_row *row;
5939 XRectangle *r;
5940 enum glyph_row_area area;
5942 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
5943 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
5944 struct glyph *last;
5945 int first_x, start_x, x;
5947 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
5948 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
5949 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area, 0, row->used[area],
5950 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5951 else
5953 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
5954 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
5955 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
5956 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5957 start_x = 0;
5958 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5959 start_x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5960 else
5961 start_x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5962 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5963 x = start_x;
5965 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
5966 while (first < end
5967 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
5969 x += first->pixel_width;
5970 ++first;
5973 /* Find the last one. */
5974 last = first;
5975 first_x = x;
5976 while (last < end
5977 && x < r->x + r->width)
5979 x += last->pixel_width;
5980 ++last;
5983 /* Repaint. */
5984 if (last > first)
5985 x_draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
5986 first - row->glyphs[area],
5987 last - row->glyphs[area],
5988 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
5993 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
5994 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
5995 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
5997 static int
5998 expose_line (w, row, r)
5999 struct window *w;
6000 struct glyph_row *row;
6001 XRectangle *r;
6003 xassert (row->enabled_p);
6005 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
6006 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA, 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
6007 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
6008 else
6010 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
6011 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6012 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
6013 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
6014 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
6015 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
6016 x_draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
6019 return row->mouse_face_p;
6023 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
6025 static int
6026 x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, r)
6027 struct window *w;
6028 XRectangle *r;
6030 XRectangle cr, result;
6031 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
6033 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
6034 if (cursor_glyph)
6036 cr.x = w->phys_cursor.x;
6037 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
6038 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
6039 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
6040 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
6042 else
6043 return 0;
6047 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
6048 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
6049 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
6050 mouse-face. */
6052 static int
6053 expose_window (w, fr)
6054 struct window *w;
6055 XRectangle *fr;
6057 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6058 XRectangle wr, r;
6059 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
6061 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
6062 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
6063 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
6064 created window. */
6065 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
6066 return 0;
6068 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
6069 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
6070 later. */
6071 if (w == updated_window)
6073 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6074 return 0;
6077 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
6078 wr.x = XFASTINT (w->left) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
6079 wr.y = XFASTINT (w->top) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f);
6080 wr.width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
6081 wr.height = XFASTINT (w->height) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f);
6083 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
6085 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
6086 struct glyph_row *row;
6087 int cursor_cleared_p;
6089 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
6090 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
6092 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
6093 r.x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, r.x);
6094 r.y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, r.y);
6096 /* Turn off the cursor. */
6097 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
6098 && x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
6100 x_clear_cursor (w);
6101 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
6103 else
6104 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
6106 /* Find the first row intersecting the rectangle R. */
6107 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
6108 row->enabled_p;
6109 ++row)
6111 int y0 = row->y;
6112 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
6114 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
6115 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
6116 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
6117 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
6119 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
6120 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
6123 if (y1 >= yb)
6124 break;
6127 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
6128 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
6129 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
6130 row->enabled_p)
6131 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
6133 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
6134 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
6137 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
6139 /* Draw border between windows. */
6140 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
6142 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
6143 if (cursor_cleared_p)
6144 x_update_window_cursor (w, 1);
6148 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
6152 /* Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
6153 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
6154 empty. */
6156 static int
6157 x_intersect_rectangles (r1, r2, result)
6158 XRectangle *r1, *r2, *result;
6160 XRectangle *left, *right;
6161 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
6162 int intersection_p = 0;
6164 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
6165 if (r1->x < r2->x)
6166 left = r1, right = r2;
6167 else
6168 left = r2, right = r1;
6170 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
6171 otherwise there is no intersection. */
6172 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
6174 result->x = right->x;
6176 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of the
6177 the right ends of left and right. */
6178 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
6179 - result->x);
6181 /* Same game for Y. */
6182 if (r1->y < r2->y)
6183 upper = r1, lower = r2;
6184 else
6185 upper = r2, lower = r1;
6187 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
6188 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
6189 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
6191 result->y = lower->y;
6193 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
6194 ends of upper and lower. */
6195 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
6196 upper->y + upper->height)
6197 - result->y);
6198 intersection_p = 1;
6202 return intersection_p;
6209 static void
6210 frame_highlight (f)
6211 struct frame *f;
6213 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
6214 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
6215 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
6216 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
6217 BLOCK_INPUT;
6218 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6219 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
6220 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6221 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6224 static void
6225 frame_unhighlight (f)
6226 struct frame *f;
6228 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
6229 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
6230 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
6231 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
6232 BLOCK_INPUT;
6233 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6234 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
6235 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6236 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6239 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
6240 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
6241 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
6242 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
6243 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
6245 static void
6246 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
6247 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6248 struct frame *frame;
6250 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6252 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6254 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
6255 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
6256 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
6258 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
6259 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
6261 #if 0
6262 selected_frame = frame;
6263 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
6264 selected_frame);
6265 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window);
6266 choose_minibuf_frame ();
6267 #endif /* ! 0 */
6269 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
6270 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6271 else
6272 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
6275 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
6278 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
6280 void
6281 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
6282 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6284 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
6287 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
6288 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
6289 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
6291 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
6292 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
6293 the appropriate X display info. */
6295 static void
6296 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
6297 struct frame *frame;
6299 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
6302 static void
6303 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
6304 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6306 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
6308 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6310 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
6311 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
6312 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
6313 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
6314 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
6316 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
6317 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6320 else
6321 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
6323 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
6325 if (old_highlight)
6326 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
6327 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
6328 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
6334 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
6336 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
6337 static void
6338 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
6339 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6341 int min_code, max_code;
6342 KeySym *syms;
6343 int syms_per_code;
6344 XModifierKeymap *mods;
6346 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
6347 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
6348 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6349 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
6350 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
6352 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
6353 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
6354 #else
6355 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
6356 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
6357 #endif
6359 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
6360 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
6361 &syms_per_code);
6362 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
6364 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
6365 Alt keysyms are on. */
6367 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
6369 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
6370 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
6372 KeyCode code
6373 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
6375 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
6376 if (code == 0)
6377 continue;
6379 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
6381 int code_col;
6383 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
6385 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
6387 switch (sym)
6389 case XK_Meta_L:
6390 case XK_Meta_R:
6391 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6392 break;
6394 case XK_Alt_L:
6395 case XK_Alt_R:
6396 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6397 break;
6399 case XK_Hyper_L:
6400 case XK_Hyper_R:
6401 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6402 break;
6404 case XK_Super_L:
6405 case XK_Super_R:
6406 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6407 break;
6409 case XK_Shift_Lock:
6410 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
6411 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
6412 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
6413 break;
6420 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
6421 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6423 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
6424 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6427 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
6428 make them just meta, not alt. */
6429 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6431 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
6434 XFree ((char *) syms);
6435 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
6438 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
6439 Emacs uses. */
6441 static unsigned int
6442 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6443 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6444 unsigned int state;
6446 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
6447 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
6448 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
6449 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
6450 Lisp_Object tem;
6452 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6453 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
6454 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6455 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
6456 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6457 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
6458 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6459 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
6462 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
6463 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
6464 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
6465 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
6466 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
6467 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
6470 static unsigned int
6471 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6473 unsigned int state;
6475 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
6476 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
6477 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
6478 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
6480 Lisp_Object tem;
6482 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
6484 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
6486 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6487 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
6488 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
6489 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
6492 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
6493 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
6494 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
6495 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
6496 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
6497 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
6500 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
6502 char *
6503 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
6504 KeySym keysym;
6506 char *value;
6508 BLOCK_INPUT;
6509 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
6510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6512 return value;
6517 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
6519 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
6520 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
6521 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
6522 not force the value into range. */
6524 void
6525 pixel_to_glyph_coords (f, pix_x, pix_y, x, y, bounds, noclip)
6526 FRAME_PTR f;
6527 register int pix_x, pix_y;
6528 register int *x, *y;
6529 XRectangle *bounds;
6530 int noclip;
6532 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to round down
6533 even for negative values. */
6534 if (pix_x < 0)
6535 pix_x -= FONT_WIDTH ((f)->output_data.x->font) - 1;
6536 if (pix_y < 0)
6537 pix_y -= (f)->output_data.x->line_height - 1;
6539 pix_x = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL (f, pix_x);
6540 pix_y = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_ROW (f, pix_y);
6542 if (bounds)
6544 bounds->width = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
6545 bounds->height = f->output_data.x->line_height;
6546 bounds->x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, pix_x);
6547 bounds->y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, pix_y);
6550 if (!noclip)
6552 if (pix_x < 0)
6553 pix_x = 0;
6554 else if (pix_x > FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f))
6555 pix_x = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f);
6557 if (pix_y < 0)
6558 pix_y = 0;
6559 else if (pix_y > f->height)
6560 pix_y = f->height;
6563 *x = pix_x;
6564 *y = pix_y;
6568 /* Given HPOS/VPOS in the current matrix of W, return corresponding
6569 frame-relative pixel positions in *FRAME_X and *FRAME_Y. If we
6570 can't tell the positions because W's display is not up to date,
6571 return 0. */
6574 glyph_to_pixel_coords (w, hpos, vpos, frame_x, frame_y)
6575 struct window *w;
6576 int hpos, vpos;
6577 int *frame_x, *frame_y;
6579 int success_p;
6581 xassert (hpos >= 0 && hpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_w);
6582 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_h);
6584 if (display_completed)
6586 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
6587 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
6588 struct glyph *end = glyph + min (hpos, row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
6590 *frame_y = row->y;
6591 *frame_x = row->x;
6592 while (glyph < end)
6594 *frame_x += glyph->pixel_width;
6595 ++glyph;
6598 success_p = 1;
6600 else
6602 *frame_y = *frame_x = 0;
6603 success_p = 0;
6606 *frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, *frame_y);
6607 *frame_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, *frame_x);
6608 return success_p;
6612 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
6614 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
6615 the mouse. */
6617 static Lisp_Object
6618 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
6619 struct input_event *result;
6620 XButtonEvent *event;
6621 struct frame *f;
6623 /* Make the event type no_event; we'll change that when we decide
6624 otherwise. */
6625 result->kind = mouse_click;
6626 result->code = event->button - Button1;
6627 result->timestamp = event->time;
6628 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6629 event->state)
6630 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
6631 ? up_modifier
6632 : down_modifier));
6634 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
6635 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
6636 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
6637 result->arg = Qnil;
6638 return Qnil;
6642 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
6643 The input handler calls this.
6645 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
6646 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
6647 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
6648 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
6650 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
6651 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
6653 static void
6654 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
6655 FRAME_PTR frame;
6656 XMotionEvent *event;
6658 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
6659 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
6660 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
6662 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
6664 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6665 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6666 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
6669 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
6670 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
6671 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
6672 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
6673 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
6675 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6676 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6677 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
6682 /************************************************************************
6683 Mouse Face
6684 ************************************************************************/
6686 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
6687 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
6688 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
6689 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
6690 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
6691 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
6692 date. */
6694 static struct glyph *
6695 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, area, buffer_only_p)
6696 struct window *w;
6697 int x, y;
6698 int *hpos, *vpos, *area;
6699 int buffer_only_p;
6701 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
6702 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
6703 int x0, i, left_area_width;
6705 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
6706 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
6708 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
6709 if (!row->enabled_p)
6710 return NULL;
6711 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
6712 break;
6715 *vpos = i;
6716 *hpos = 0;
6718 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
6719 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
6720 return NULL;
6722 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
6723 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6725 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6726 x0 = 0;
6728 else
6730 left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6731 if (x < left_area_width)
6733 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
6734 x0 = 0;
6736 else if (x < left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA))
6738 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6739 x0 = row->x + left_area_width;
6741 else
6743 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
6744 x0 = left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
6748 /* Find glyph containing X. */
6749 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
6750 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
6751 while (glyph < end)
6753 if (x < x0 + glyph->pixel_width)
6755 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6756 break;
6757 else if (!buffer_only_p || BUFFERP (glyph->object))
6758 break;
6761 x0 += glyph->pixel_width;
6762 ++glyph;
6765 if (glyph == end)
6766 return NULL;
6768 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
6769 return glyph;
6773 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
6774 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
6776 static void
6777 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, x, y)
6778 struct window *w;
6779 int *x, *y;
6781 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6783 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
6784 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
6785 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6786 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH_SAFE (f);
6787 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6789 else
6791 *x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, *x);
6792 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6797 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
6798 or marginal area of window W, x-position X and y-position Y. Area
6799 is 1, 3, 6 or 7 for the mode line, header line, left and right
6800 marginal area respectively. X is relative to the start of the text
6801 display area of W, so the width of bitmap areas and scroll bars
6802 must be subtracted to get a position relative to the start of the
6803 mode line. */
6805 static void
6806 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (w, x, y, portion)
6807 struct window *w;
6808 int x, y, portion;
6810 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6811 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6812 Cursor cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
6813 int charpos;
6814 Lisp_Object string, help, map, pos;
6816 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3)
6817 string = mode_line_string (w, x, y, portion == 1, &charpos);
6818 else
6819 string = marginal_area_string (w, x, y, portion, &charpos);
6821 if (STRINGP (string))
6823 pos = make_number (charpos);
6825 /* If we're on a string with `help-echo' text property, arrange
6826 for the help to be displayed. This is done by setting the
6827 global variable help_echo to the help string. */
6828 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
6829 if (!NILP (help))
6831 help_echo = help;
6832 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
6833 help_echo_object = string;
6834 help_echo_pos = charpos;
6837 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
6838 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
6839 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
6840 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
6841 if (KEYMAPP (map))
6842 cursor = f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor;
6845 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
6849 /* Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
6850 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
6851 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
6852 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
6854 static void
6855 note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y)
6856 struct frame *f;
6857 int x, y;
6859 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6860 int portion;
6861 Lisp_Object window;
6862 struct window *w;
6863 Cursor cursor = None;
6864 struct buffer *b;
6866 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
6867 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6868 if (popup_activated ())
6869 return;
6870 #endif
6872 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
6873 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
6874 return;
6876 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
6877 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
6878 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
6880 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer)
6881 return;
6883 if (gc_in_progress)
6885 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
6886 return;
6889 /* Which window is that in? */
6890 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &portion, 1);
6892 /* If we were displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
6893 if (! EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
6894 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6896 /* Not on a window -> return. */
6897 if (!WINDOWP (window))
6898 return;
6900 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
6901 w = XWINDOW (window);
6902 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
6904 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
6905 buffer. */
6906 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6908 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
6909 return;
6912 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
6913 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3 || portion == 6 || portion == 7)
6915 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (w, x, y, portion);
6916 return;
6919 if (portion == 2)
6920 cursor = f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor;
6921 else
6922 cursor = f->output_data.x->text_cursor;
6924 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
6925 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
6926 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
6927 if (/* Within text portion of the window. */
6928 portion == 0
6929 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
6930 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) == BUF_MODIFF (b)
6931 && XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified) == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
6933 int hpos, vpos, pos, i, area;
6934 struct glyph *glyph;
6935 Lisp_Object object;
6936 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, overlay = Qnil, position;
6937 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
6938 int len, noverlays;
6939 struct buffer *obuf;
6940 int obegv, ozv, same_region;
6942 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
6943 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &area, 0);
6945 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
6946 if (glyph == NULL
6947 || area != TEXT_AREA
6948 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p)
6950 if (clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo))
6951 cursor = None;
6952 goto set_cursor;
6955 pos = glyph->charpos;
6956 object = glyph->object;
6957 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
6958 goto set_cursor;
6960 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
6961 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
6962 goto set_cursor;
6964 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
6965 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
6966 obuf = current_buffer;
6967 current_buffer = b;
6968 obegv = BEGV;
6969 ozv = ZV;
6970 BEGV = BEG;
6971 ZV = Z;
6973 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
6974 position = make_number (pos);
6976 if (BUFFERP (object))
6978 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec.
6979 Store the length in len. If there are more than 10, make
6980 enough space for all, and try again. */
6981 len = 10;
6982 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6983 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL, 0);
6984 if (noverlays > len)
6986 len = noverlays;
6987 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6988 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL,0);
6991 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
6992 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
6994 else
6995 noverlays = 0;
6997 same_region = (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
6998 && vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6999 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7000 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7001 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
7002 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7003 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
7004 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end));
7006 if (same_region)
7007 cursor = None;
7009 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
7010 if (! same_region
7011 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
7012 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
7013 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
7014 highlight only that. */
7015 || (OVERLAYP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
7016 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
7018 /* Find the highest priority overlay that has a mouse-face
7019 property. */
7020 overlay = Qnil;
7021 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
7023 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
7024 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
7025 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
7028 /* If we're actually highlighting the same overlay as
7029 before, there's no need to do that again. */
7030 if (!NILP (overlay)
7031 && EQ (overlay, dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
7032 goto check_help_echo;
7034 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
7036 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
7037 if (clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo))
7038 cursor = None;
7040 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
7041 if (NILP (overlay))
7042 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
7044 /* Handle the overlay case. */
7045 if (!NILP (overlay))
7047 /* Find the range of text around this char that
7048 should be active. */
7049 Lisp_Object before, after;
7050 int ignore;
7052 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
7053 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
7054 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7055 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7056 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7057 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7058 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7059 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, Qnil);
7061 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7062 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7063 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7064 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7065 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7066 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, Qnil);
7067 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7068 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7069 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7070 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7072 /* Display it as active. */
7073 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7074 cursor = None;
7076 /* Handle the text property case. */
7077 else if (!NILP (mouse_face) && BUFFERP (object))
7079 /* Find the range of text around this char that
7080 should be active. */
7081 Lisp_Object before, after, beginning, end;
7082 int ignore;
7084 beginning = Fmarker_position (w->start);
7085 end = make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (object))
7086 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos));
7087 before
7088 = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
7089 Qmouse_face,
7090 object, beginning);
7091 after
7092 = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
7093 object, end);
7095 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7096 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7097 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7098 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7099 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7100 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, Qnil);
7101 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7102 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7103 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7104 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7105 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7106 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, Qnil);
7107 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7109 if (BUFFERP (object))
7110 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7111 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7112 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7114 /* Display it as active. */
7115 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7116 cursor = None;
7118 else if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
7120 Lisp_Object b, e;
7121 int ignore;
7123 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
7124 Qmouse_face,
7125 object, Qnil);
7126 e = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
7127 object, Qnil);
7128 if (NILP (b))
7129 b = make_number (0);
7130 if (NILP (e))
7131 e = make_number (XSTRING (object)->size - 1);
7132 fast_find_string_pos (w, XINT (b), object,
7133 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7134 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7135 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7136 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y, 0);
7137 fast_find_string_pos (w, XINT (e), object,
7138 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7139 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7140 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7141 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y, 1);
7142 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7143 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7144 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7145 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
7146 glyph->face_id, 1);
7147 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7148 cursor = None;
7150 else if (STRINGP (object) && NILP (mouse_face))
7152 /* A string which doesn't have mouse-face, but
7153 the text ``under'' it might have. */
7154 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7155 int start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
7157 pos = string_buffer_position (w, object, start);
7158 if (pos > 0)
7159 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (pos),
7160 Qmouse_face,
7161 w->buffer,
7162 &overlay);
7163 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && !NILP (overlay))
7165 Lisp_Object before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
7166 Lisp_Object after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
7167 int ignore;
7169 /* Note that we might not be able to find position
7170 BEFORE in the glyph matrix if the overlay is
7171 entirely covered by a `display' property. In
7172 this case, we overshoot. So let's stop in
7173 the glyph matrix before glyphs for OBJECT. */
7174 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7175 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7176 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7177 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7178 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y,
7179 object);
7181 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7182 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7183 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7184 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7185 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7186 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y,
7187 Qnil);
7188 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7189 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7190 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7191 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7193 /* Display it as active. */
7194 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7195 cursor = None;
7200 check_help_echo:
7202 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
7204 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
7206 /* Check overlays first. */
7207 help = overlay = Qnil;
7208 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
7210 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
7211 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
7214 if (!NILP (help))
7216 help_echo = help;
7217 help_echo_window = window;
7218 help_echo_object = overlay;
7219 help_echo_pos = pos;
7221 else
7223 Lisp_Object object = glyph->object;
7224 int charpos = glyph->charpos;
7226 /* Try text properties. */
7227 if (STRINGP (object)
7228 && charpos >= 0
7229 && charpos < XSTRING (object)->size)
7231 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
7232 Qhelp_echo, object);
7233 if (NILP (help))
7235 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
7236 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
7237 struct glyph_row *r
7238 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7239 int start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
7240 int pos = string_buffer_position (w, object, start);
7241 if (pos > 0)
7243 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (pos),
7244 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
7245 if (!NILP (help))
7247 charpos = pos;
7248 object = w->buffer;
7253 else if (BUFFERP (object)
7254 && charpos >= BEGV
7255 && charpos < ZV)
7256 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
7257 object);
7259 if (!NILP (help))
7261 help_echo = help;
7262 help_echo_window = window;
7263 help_echo_object = object;
7264 help_echo_pos = charpos;
7269 BEGV = obegv;
7270 ZV = ozv;
7271 current_buffer = obuf;
7274 set_cursor:
7276 if (cursor != None)
7277 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7280 static void
7281 redo_mouse_highlight ()
7283 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
7284 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
7285 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
7286 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
7287 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
7292 /***********************************************************************
7293 Tool-bars
7294 ***********************************************************************/
7296 static int x_tool_bar_item P_ ((struct frame *, int, int,
7297 struct glyph **, int *, int *, int *));
7299 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
7300 or -1. */
7302 static int last_tool_bar_item;
7305 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
7306 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
7307 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
7308 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
7309 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
7311 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
7312 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
7313 1 otherwise. */
7315 static int
7316 x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, glyph, hpos, vpos, prop_idx)
7317 struct frame *f;
7318 int x, y;
7319 struct glyph **glyph;
7320 int *hpos, *vpos, *prop_idx;
7322 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7323 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7324 int area;
7326 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
7327 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, &area, 0);
7328 if (*glyph == NULL)
7329 return -1;
7331 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
7332 f->tool_bar_items. */
7333 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
7334 return -1;
7336 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
7337 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
7338 && *vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7339 && *vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7340 && (*vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7341 || *hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
7342 && (*vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7343 || *hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
7344 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
7345 return 0;
7347 return 1;
7351 /* Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
7352 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. EVENT_TYPE is either ButtonPress
7353 or ButtonRelase. */
7355 static void
7356 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, button_event)
7357 struct frame *f;
7358 XButtonEvent *button_event;
7360 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7361 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7362 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
7363 struct glyph *glyph;
7364 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7365 int x = button_event->x;
7366 int y = button_event->y;
7368 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
7369 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
7370 if (x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
7371 return;
7373 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
7374 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
7375 if (NILP (enabled_p))
7376 return;
7378 if (button_event->type == ButtonPress)
7380 /* Show item in pressed state. */
7381 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
7382 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
7383 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
7385 else
7387 Lisp_Object key, frame;
7388 struct input_event event;
7390 /* Show item in released state. */
7391 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
7392 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7394 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
7396 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7397 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7398 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7399 event.arg = frame;
7400 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7402 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7403 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7404 event.arg = key;
7405 event.modifiers = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
7406 button_event->state);
7407 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7408 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7413 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
7414 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
7415 note_mouse_highlight. */
7417 static void
7418 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y)
7419 struct frame *f;
7420 int x, y;
7422 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
7423 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
7424 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7425 int hpos, vpos;
7426 struct glyph *glyph;
7427 struct glyph_row *row;
7428 int i;
7429 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7430 int prop_idx;
7431 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7432 int mouse_down_p, rc;
7434 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative x(y
7435 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
7436 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
7438 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7439 return;
7442 rc = x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
7443 if (rc < 0)
7445 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
7446 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7447 return;
7449 else if (rc == 0)
7450 goto set_help_echo;
7452 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7454 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
7455 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
7456 && f == last_mouse_frame
7457 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
7458 if (mouse_down_p
7459 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
7460 return;
7462 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
7463 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7465 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
7466 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
7467 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
7469 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
7470 image is a space. We include this is the highlighted area. */
7471 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7472 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
7473 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
7475 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7476 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
7477 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
7478 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
7479 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
7480 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7482 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
7483 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
7484 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
7485 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
7486 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7487 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
7489 /* Display it as active. */
7490 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw);
7491 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
7494 set_help_echo:
7496 /* Set help_echo to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
7497 XTread_socket does the rest. */
7498 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
7499 help_echo_pos = -1;
7500 help_echo = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
7501 if (NILP (help_echo))
7502 help_echo = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
7507 /* Find the glyph matrix position of buffer position CHARPOS in window
7508 *W. HPOS, *VPOS, *X, and *Y are set to the positions found. W's
7509 current glyphs must be up to date. If CHARPOS is above window
7510 start return (0, 0, 0, 0). If CHARPOS is after end of W, return end
7511 of last line in W. In the row containing CHARPOS, stop before glyphs
7512 having STOP as object. */
7514 #if 0 /* This is a version of fast_find_position that's more correct
7515 in the presence of hscrolling, for example. I didn't install
7516 it right away because the problem fixed is minor, it failed
7517 in 20.x as well, and I think it's too risky to install
7518 so near the release of 21.1. 2001-09-25 gerd. */
7520 static int
7521 fast_find_position (w, charpos, hpos, vpos, x, y, stop)
7522 struct window *w;
7523 int charpos;
7524 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7525 Lisp_Object stop;
7527 struct glyph_row *row, *first;
7528 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
7529 int i, past_end = 0;
7531 first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7532 row = row_containing_pos (w, charpos, first, NULL, 0);
7533 if (row == NULL)
7535 if (charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first))
7537 *x = *y = *hpos = *vpos = 0;
7538 return 0;
7540 else
7542 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
7543 past_end = 1;
7547 *x = row->x;
7548 *y = row->y;
7549 *vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix);
7551 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7552 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
7554 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start of the row.
7555 These are special glyphs like truncation marks on terminal
7556 frames. */
7557 if (row->displays_text_p)
7558 while (glyph < end
7559 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
7560 && !EQ (stop, glyph->object)
7561 && glyph->charpos < 0)
7563 *x += glyph->pixel_width;
7564 ++glyph;
7567 while (glyph < end
7568 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
7569 && !EQ (stop, glyph->object)
7570 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
7571 || glyph->charpos < charpos))
7573 *x += glyph->pixel_width;
7574 ++glyph;
7577 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7578 return past_end;
7581 #else /* not 0 */
7583 static int
7584 fast_find_position (w, pos, hpos, vpos, x, y, stop)
7585 struct window *w;
7586 int pos;
7587 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7588 Lisp_Object stop;
7590 int i;
7591 int lastcol;
7592 int maybe_next_line_p = 0;
7593 int line_start_position;
7594 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7595 struct glyph_row *row, *best_row;
7596 int row_vpos, best_row_vpos;
7597 int current_x;
7599 row = best_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7600 row_vpos = best_row_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix);
7602 while (row->y < yb)
7604 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7605 line_start_position = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos;
7606 else
7607 line_start_position = 0;
7609 if (line_start_position > pos)
7610 break;
7611 /* If the position sought is the end of the buffer,
7612 don't include the blank lines at the bottom of the window. */
7613 else if (line_start_position == pos
7614 && pos == BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
7616 maybe_next_line_p = 1;
7617 break;
7619 else if (line_start_position > 0)
7621 best_row = row;
7622 best_row_vpos = row_vpos;
7625 if (row->y + row->height >= yb)
7626 break;
7628 ++row;
7629 ++row_vpos;
7632 /* Find the right column within BEST_ROW. */
7633 lastcol = 0;
7634 current_x = best_row->x;
7635 for (i = 0; i < best_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
7637 struct glyph *glyph = best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + i;
7638 int charpos = glyph->charpos;
7640 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
7642 if (charpos == pos)
7644 *hpos = i;
7645 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7646 *x = current_x;
7647 *y = best_row->y;
7648 return 1;
7650 else if (charpos > pos)
7651 break;
7653 else if (EQ (glyph->object, stop))
7654 break;
7656 if (charpos > 0)
7657 lastcol = i;
7658 current_x += glyph->pixel_width;
7661 /* If we're looking for the end of the buffer,
7662 and we didn't find it in the line we scanned,
7663 use the start of the following line. */
7664 if (maybe_next_line_p)
7666 ++best_row;
7667 ++best_row_vpos;
7668 lastcol = 0;
7669 current_x = best_row->x;
7672 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7673 *hpos = lastcol + 1;
7674 *x = current_x;
7675 *y = best_row->y;
7676 return 0;
7679 #endif /* not 0 */
7682 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
7683 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
7684 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
7686 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
7687 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
7689 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
7690 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
7691 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
7692 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
7693 next larger position in OBJECT.
7695 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
7697 static int
7698 fast_find_string_pos (w, pos, object, hpos, vpos, x, y, right_p)
7699 struct window *w;
7700 int pos;
7701 Lisp_Object object;
7702 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7703 int right_p;
7705 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7706 struct glyph_row *r;
7707 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
7708 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
7709 int best_x = 0;
7711 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7712 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
7713 ++r)
7715 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7716 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
7717 int gx;
7719 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
7720 if (EQ (g->object, object))
7722 if (g->charpos == pos)
7724 best_glyph = g;
7725 best_x = gx;
7726 best_row = r;
7727 goto found;
7729 else if (best_glyph == NULL
7730 || ((abs (g->charpos - pos)
7731 < abs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
7732 && (right_p
7733 ? g->charpos < pos
7734 : g->charpos > pos)))
7736 best_glyph = g;
7737 best_x = gx;
7738 best_row = r;
7743 found:
7745 if (best_glyph)
7747 *x = best_x;
7748 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7750 if (right_p)
7752 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
7753 ++*hpos;
7756 *y = best_row->y;
7757 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
7760 return best_glyph != NULL;
7764 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_*
7765 in its mouse-face if HL > 0, in its normal face if HL = 0. */
7767 static void
7768 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw)
7769 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7770 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7772 struct window *w = XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window);
7773 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7775 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
7776 to do anything. */
7777 w->current_matrix != NULL
7778 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
7779 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
7780 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
7781 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
7782 && dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
7784 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
7785 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
7787 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
7788 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
7790 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
7792 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
7794 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
7795 if (row == first)
7797 start_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
7798 start_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
7800 else
7802 start_hpos = 0;
7803 start_x = 0;
7806 if (row == last)
7807 end_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
7808 else
7809 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
7811 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
7813 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA,
7814 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
7816 row->mouse_face_p
7817 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7821 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
7822 be displayed again. */
7823 if (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
7824 x_display_cursor (w, 1,
7825 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
7826 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
7829 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
7830 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
7831 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7832 f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
7833 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
7834 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7835 f->output_data.x->cross_cursor);
7836 else
7837 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7838 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
7841 /* Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
7842 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
7843 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
7845 static int
7846 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo)
7847 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7849 int cleared = 0;
7851 if (!NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7853 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
7854 cleared = 1;
7857 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7858 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7859 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7860 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
7861 return cleared;
7865 /* Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
7866 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
7867 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
7869 static void
7870 x_clear_mouse_face (w)
7871 struct window *w;
7873 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
7874 Lisp_Object window;
7876 BLOCK_INPUT;
7877 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
7878 if (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7879 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7880 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7884 /* Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
7885 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
7887 void
7888 cancel_mouse_face (f)
7889 FRAME_PTR f;
7891 Lisp_Object window;
7892 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7894 window = dpyinfo->mouse_face_window;
7895 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
7897 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7898 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7899 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7904 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
7907 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
7908 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
7909 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
7910 values. */
7912 static int
7913 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
7914 struct frame *f;
7915 int x, y;
7916 XRectangle *rect;
7918 Lisp_Object window;
7919 int part, found = 0;
7921 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 0);
7922 if (!NILP (window))
7924 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
7925 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
7926 struct glyph_row *end = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
7928 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
7930 for (; !found && r < end && r->enabled_p; ++r)
7931 if (r->y >= y)
7933 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
7934 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
7935 int gx;
7937 for (gx = r->x; !found && g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
7938 if (gx >= x)
7940 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
7941 rect->height = r->height;
7942 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
7943 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
7944 found = 1;
7949 return found;
7953 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
7954 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
7956 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
7957 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
7958 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
7959 position on the scroll bar.
7961 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
7962 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
7963 the mouse is over.
7965 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
7966 was at this position.
7968 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
7970 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
7971 movement. */
7973 static void
7974 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
7975 FRAME_PTR *fp;
7976 int insist;
7977 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
7978 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
7979 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
7980 unsigned long *time;
7982 FRAME_PTR f1;
7984 BLOCK_INPUT;
7986 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
7987 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
7988 else
7990 Window root;
7991 int root_x, root_y;
7993 Window dummy_window;
7994 int dummy;
7996 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7998 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
7999 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8000 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
8001 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
8003 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
8005 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
8006 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8007 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
8009 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
8010 &root,
8012 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
8013 a different screen. */
8014 &dummy_window,
8016 /* The position on that root window. */
8017 &root_x, &root_y,
8019 /* More trash we can't trust. */
8020 &dummy, &dummy,
8022 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
8023 we don't care. */
8024 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
8026 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
8027 containing the pointer. */
8029 Window win, child;
8030 int win_x, win_y;
8031 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
8032 int count;
8034 win = root;
8036 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
8037 structure is changing at the same time this function
8038 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
8040 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
8042 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
8043 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
8045 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
8046 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
8047 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8049 /* From-window, to-window. */
8050 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
8052 /* From-position, to-position. */
8053 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
8055 /* Child of win. */
8056 &child);
8057 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
8059 else
8061 while (1)
8063 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
8065 /* From-window, to-window. */
8066 root, win,
8068 /* From-position, to-position. */
8069 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
8071 /* Child of win. */
8072 &child);
8074 if (child == None || child == win)
8075 break;
8077 win = child;
8078 parent_x = win_x;
8079 parent_y = win_y;
8082 /* Now we know that:
8083 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
8084 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
8085 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
8086 (XTC did this the last time through), and
8087 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
8088 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
8089 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
8090 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
8091 never use them in that case.) */
8093 /* Is win one of our frames? */
8094 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
8096 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8097 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
8098 on the frame. */
8099 if (f1 != NULL
8100 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
8101 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
8102 f1 = NULL;
8103 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8106 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
8107 f1 = 0;
8109 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
8111 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
8112 if (! f1)
8114 struct scroll_bar *bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (win);
8116 if (bar)
8118 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8119 win_x = parent_x;
8120 win_y = parent_y;
8124 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
8125 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
8127 if (f1)
8129 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
8130 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
8131 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
8132 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
8133 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
8134 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
8135 the frame are divided into. */
8137 int width, height, gx, gy;
8138 XRectangle rect;
8140 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
8141 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
8142 else
8144 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
8145 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
8146 gx = win_x;
8147 gy = win_y;
8149 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to
8150 round down even for negative values. */
8151 if (gx < 0)
8152 gx -= width - 1;
8153 if (gy < 0)
8154 gy -= height - 1;
8155 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
8156 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
8158 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
8159 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
8160 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
8161 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
8164 *bar_window = Qnil;
8165 *part = 0;
8166 *fp = f1;
8167 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
8168 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
8169 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
8174 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8178 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8180 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
8181 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
8182 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
8183 that slows us down. */
8185 static void
8186 x_process_timeouts (timer)
8187 struct atimer *timer;
8189 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated_flag)
8191 BLOCK_INPUT;
8192 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
8193 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
8194 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8198 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8201 /* Scroll bar support. */
8203 /* Given an X window ID, find the struct scroll_bar which manages it.
8204 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
8205 bits. */
8207 static struct scroll_bar *
8208 x_window_to_scroll_bar (window_id)
8209 Window window_id;
8211 Lisp_Object tail;
8213 for (tail = Vframe_list;
8214 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
8215 tail = XCDR (tail))
8217 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
8219 frame = XCAR (tail);
8220 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
8221 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
8222 abort ();
8224 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
8225 right window ID. */
8226 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
8227 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
8228 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
8229 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
8230 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
8231 condemned = Qnil,
8232 ! GC_NILP (bar));
8233 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
8234 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id)
8235 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8238 return 0;
8242 #if defined USE_LUCID
8244 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
8245 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
8247 static Widget
8248 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
8249 Window window;
8251 Lisp_Object tail;
8253 for (tail = Vframe_list;
8254 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
8255 tail = XCDR (tail))
8257 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
8258 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
8260 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
8261 return menu_bar;
8264 return NULL;
8267 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
8270 /************************************************************************
8271 Toolkit scroll bars
8272 ************************************************************************/
8274 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8276 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
8277 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
8278 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
8279 struct scroll_bar *));
8280 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
8281 int, int, int));
8284 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
8286 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
8288 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
8289 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
8291 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
8293 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
8295 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
8297 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
8298 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
8300 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
8302 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
8303 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
8304 to avoid jerkyness. */
8306 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
8309 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
8310 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
8311 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
8312 a `end-scroll' scroll_bar_click' event if so. */
8314 static void
8315 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
8316 num_params)
8317 Widget widget;
8318 XtPointer client_data;
8319 String action_name;
8320 XEvent *event;
8321 String *params;
8322 Cardinal *num_params;
8324 int scroll_bar_p;
8325 char *end_action;
8327 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8328 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
8329 end_action = "Release";
8330 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8331 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
8332 end_action = "EndScroll";
8333 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
8335 if (scroll_bar_p
8336 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
8337 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
8339 struct window *w;
8341 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
8342 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
8343 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
8344 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
8345 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
8346 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
8348 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
8349 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
8353 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
8354 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
8356 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
8357 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
8360 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
8361 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
8362 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
8363 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
8365 static void
8366 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
8367 Lisp_Object window;
8368 int part, portion, whole;
8370 XEvent event;
8371 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
8372 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
8373 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8374 int i;
8376 BLOCK_INPUT;
8378 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
8379 ev->type = ClientMessage;
8380 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
8381 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8382 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8383 ev->format = 32;
8385 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
8386 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
8387 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
8388 into that array in the event. */
8389 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
8390 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
8391 break;
8393 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
8395 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
8396 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
8397 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
8399 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
8400 nbytes);
8401 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
8402 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
8405 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
8406 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
8407 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
8408 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
8409 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
8410 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
8412 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
8413 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
8415 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
8416 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
8417 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
8418 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
8419 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8423 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
8424 in *IEVENT. */
8426 static void
8427 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
8428 XEvent *event;
8429 struct input_event *ievent;
8431 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
8432 Lisp_Object window;
8433 struct frame *f;
8434 struct window *w;
8436 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
8437 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
8439 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
8440 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8442 ievent->kind = scroll_bar_click;
8443 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
8444 ievent->arg = Qnil;
8445 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8446 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
8447 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
8448 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
8449 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
8450 ievent->modifiers = 0;
8454 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8456 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
8458 #define XM_SB_MIN 1
8459 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
8460 #define XM_SB_RANGE (XM_SB_MAX - XM_SB_MIN)
8463 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
8464 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
8465 CALL_DATA is a pointer a a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
8467 static void
8468 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8469 Widget widget;
8470 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8472 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8473 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
8474 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
8476 switch (cs->reason)
8478 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
8479 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8480 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
8481 break;
8483 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
8484 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8485 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8486 break;
8488 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
8489 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8490 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8491 break;
8493 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
8494 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8495 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8496 break;
8498 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
8499 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8500 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
8501 break;
8503 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
8504 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8505 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
8506 break;
8508 case XmCR_DRAG:
8510 int slider_size;
8511 int dragging_down_p = (INTEGERP (bar->dragging)
8512 && XINT (bar->dragging) <= cs->value);
8514 /* Get the slider size. */
8515 BLOCK_INPUT;
8516 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
8517 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8519 whole = XM_SB_RANGE - slider_size;
8520 portion = min (cs->value - XM_SB_MIN, whole);
8521 part = scroll_bar_handle;
8522 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
8524 break;
8526 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
8527 break;
8530 if (part >= 0)
8532 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8533 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8534 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
8539 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw. */
8542 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
8543 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
8544 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
8545 the thumb is. */
8547 static void
8548 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8549 Widget widget;
8550 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8552 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8553 float top = *(float *) call_data;
8554 float shown;
8555 int whole, portion, height;
8556 int part;
8558 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
8559 BLOCK_INPUT;
8560 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8561 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8563 whole = 10000000;
8564 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
8566 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
8567 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
8568 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
8569 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
8570 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
8571 bottom). */
8572 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8573 else
8574 part = scroll_bar_handle;
8576 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8577 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
8578 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8579 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
8583 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
8584 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
8585 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
8586 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
8587 has taken place. It's magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
8588 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
8589 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
8591 static void
8592 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
8593 Widget widget;
8594 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
8596 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
8597 int position = (int) call_data;
8598 Dimension height;
8599 int part;
8601 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
8602 BLOCK_INPUT;
8603 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8604 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8606 if (abs (position) >= height)
8607 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
8609 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
8610 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
8611 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
8612 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8613 else
8614 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
8616 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
8617 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8618 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
8619 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
8623 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
8626 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
8627 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
8629 static void
8630 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
8631 struct frame *f;
8632 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8634 Window xwindow;
8635 Widget widget;
8636 Arg av[20];
8637 int ac = 0;
8638 char *scroll_bar_name = "verticalScrollBar";
8639 unsigned long pixel;
8641 BLOCK_INPUT;
8643 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8644 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
8645 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
8646 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, XM_SB_MIN); ++ac;
8647 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
8648 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
8649 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
8650 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
8651 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
8653 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
8654 if (pixel != -1)
8656 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
8657 ++ac;
8660 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8661 if (pixel != -1)
8663 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
8664 ++ac;
8667 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
8668 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
8670 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
8671 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8672 (XtPointer) bar);
8673 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8674 (XtPointer) bar);
8675 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8676 (XtPointer) bar);
8677 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8678 (XtPointer) bar);
8679 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8680 (XtPointer) bar);
8681 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8682 (XtPointer) bar);
8683 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
8684 (XtPointer) bar);
8686 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
8687 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
8689 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
8690 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
8691 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
8692 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
8694 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8696 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
8697 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
8698 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
8699 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
8700 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
8701 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
8702 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
8703 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
8705 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
8706 if (pixel != -1)
8708 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
8709 ++ac;
8712 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8713 if (pixel != -1)
8715 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
8716 ++ac;
8719 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
8721 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
8722 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
8724 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8725 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
8726 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
8727 pixel = -1;
8728 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
8730 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
8732 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8733 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
8734 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
8735 pixel = -1;
8736 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
8739 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
8740 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
8741 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
8742 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
8743 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
8745 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
8746 ++ac;
8748 else
8749 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
8750 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
8751 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
8753 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
8754 the shadows. */
8755 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
8756 ++ac;
8758 /* Specify the colors. */
8759 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
8760 if (pixel != -1)
8762 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
8763 ++ac;
8765 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
8766 if (pixel != -1)
8768 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
8769 ++ac;
8773 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
8774 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
8777 char *initial = "";
8778 char *val = initial;
8779 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
8780 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
8781 if (val == initial)
8782 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
8783 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
8784 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
8785 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
8789 /* Define callbacks. */
8790 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
8791 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
8792 (XtPointer) bar);
8794 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
8795 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
8797 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
8799 /* Install an action hook that let's us detect when the user
8800 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
8801 if (action_hook_id == 0)
8802 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
8804 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
8805 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
8806 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
8807 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
8809 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8813 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
8814 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
8816 static void
8817 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
8818 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8819 int portion, position, whole;
8821 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
8822 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
8823 float top, shown;
8825 BLOCK_INPUT;
8827 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
8829 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
8830 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
8831 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
8832 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
8833 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
8834 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
8835 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
8836 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
8837 its size, the update will often happen too late.
8838 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
8839 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
8840 portion = XFASTINT (XWINDOW (bar->window)->height) * 30;
8841 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
8842 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
8843 whole += portion;
8845 if (whole <= 0)
8846 top = 0, shown = 1;
8847 else
8849 top = (float) position / whole;
8850 shown = (float) portion / whole;
8853 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
8855 int size, value;
8857 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
8858 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
8859 value. */
8860 size = shown * XM_SB_RANGE;
8861 size = min (size, XM_SB_RANGE);
8862 size = max (size, 1);
8864 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
8865 value = top * XM_SB_RANGE;
8866 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
8867 value = max (value, XM_SB_MIN);
8869 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
8871 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
8873 if (whole == 0)
8874 top = 0, shown = 1;
8875 else
8877 top = (float) position / whole;
8878 shown = (float) portion / whole;
8882 float old_top, old_shown;
8883 Dimension height;
8884 XtVaGetValues (widget,
8885 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
8886 XtNshown, &old_shown,
8887 XtNheight, &height,
8888 NULL);
8890 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
8891 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
8892 top = max (0, min (1, top));
8893 else
8894 top = old_top;
8895 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
8896 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
8898 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
8899 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
8900 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
8901 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
8903 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
8904 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
8905 else
8907 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
8908 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
8909 int scroll_mode = 0;
8911 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
8912 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
8914 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
8915 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
8916 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
8917 if (scroll_mode == 2)
8918 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
8920 #endif
8921 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
8922 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
8923 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
8925 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
8927 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
8928 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
8929 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
8930 #endif
8934 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
8936 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8939 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8943 /************************************************************************
8944 Scroll bars, general
8945 ************************************************************************/
8947 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
8948 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
8949 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
8950 scroll bar. */
8952 static struct scroll_bar *
8953 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
8954 struct window *w;
8955 int top, left, width, height;
8957 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8958 struct scroll_bar *bar
8959 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
8961 BLOCK_INPUT;
8963 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8964 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
8965 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8967 XSetWindowAttributes a;
8968 unsigned long mask;
8969 Window window;
8971 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
8972 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
8973 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
8975 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
8976 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
8977 | ExposureMask);
8978 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
8980 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
8982 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
8983 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
8984 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
8985 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
8986 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8987 left, top, width,
8988 window_box_height (w), False);
8990 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8991 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
8992 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
8993 top,
8994 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
8995 height,
8996 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
8998 CopyFromParent,
8999 CopyFromParent,
9000 CopyFromParent,
9001 /* Attributes. */
9002 mask, &a);
9003 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
9005 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9007 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
9008 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
9009 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
9010 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
9011 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
9012 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
9013 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
9014 bar->dragging = Qnil;
9016 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
9017 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9018 bar->prev = Qnil;
9019 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
9020 if (!NILP (bar->next))
9021 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
9023 /* Map the window/widget. */
9024 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9026 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
9027 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
9028 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9029 top,
9030 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9031 max (height, 1), 0);
9032 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
9034 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9035 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9036 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9038 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9039 return bar;
9043 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
9045 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
9046 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
9047 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
9048 events.)
9050 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
9051 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
9052 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
9053 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
9054 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
9056 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9058 static void
9059 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
9060 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9061 int start, end;
9062 int rebuild;
9064 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
9065 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9066 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9067 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
9069 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
9070 if (! rebuild
9071 && start == XINT (bar->start)
9072 && end == XINT (bar->end))
9073 return;
9075 BLOCK_INPUT;
9078 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
9079 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9080 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9082 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
9083 the distance between start and end. */
9085 int length = end - start;
9087 if (start < 0)
9088 start = 0;
9089 else if (start > top_range)
9090 start = top_range;
9091 end = start + length;
9093 if (end < start)
9094 end = start;
9095 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
9096 end = top_range;
9099 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
9100 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
9101 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
9103 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
9104 if (end > top_range)
9105 end = top_range;
9107 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
9108 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
9109 that many pixels tall. */
9110 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
9112 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
9113 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
9114 if (0 < start)
9115 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9116 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
9117 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9118 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
9119 inside_width, start,
9120 False);
9122 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
9123 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9124 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
9125 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9127 /* Draw the handle itself. */
9128 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
9129 /* x, y, width, height */
9130 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9131 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
9132 inside_width, end - start);
9134 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
9135 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9136 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
9137 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9139 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
9140 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
9141 if (end < inside_height)
9142 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9143 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
9144 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
9145 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
9146 inside_width, inside_height - end,
9147 False);
9151 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9154 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9156 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
9157 nil. */
9159 static void
9160 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
9161 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9163 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9164 BLOCK_INPUT;
9166 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9167 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
9168 #else
9169 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
9170 #endif
9172 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
9173 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
9175 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9179 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
9180 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
9181 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
9182 create one. */
9184 static void
9185 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
9186 struct window *w;
9187 int portion, whole, position;
9189 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
9190 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9191 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
9192 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
9194 /* Get window dimensions. */
9195 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
9196 top = window_y;
9197 width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9198 height = window_height;
9200 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
9201 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9202 left = XINT (w->left) + XINT (w->width) - FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f);
9203 else
9204 left = XFASTINT (w->left);
9205 left *= CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9206 left += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
9208 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
9209 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
9210 if (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0)
9211 sb_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9212 else
9213 sb_width = width;
9215 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
9216 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9217 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9218 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
9219 else
9220 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
9221 #else
9222 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
9223 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
9224 else
9225 sb_left = left;
9226 #endif
9228 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
9229 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
9231 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
9233 BLOCK_INPUT;
9234 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9235 left, top, width, height, False);
9236 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9239 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
9241 else
9243 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
9244 unsigned int mask = 0;
9246 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
9248 BLOCK_INPUT;
9250 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
9251 mask |= CWX;
9252 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
9253 mask |= CWY;
9254 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
9255 mask |= CWWidth;
9256 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
9257 mask |= CWHeight;
9259 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9261 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
9262 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
9263 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
9264 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9265 left, top, width, height, False);
9267 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
9268 if (mask)
9269 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
9270 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9271 top,
9272 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
9273 max (height, 1), 0);
9275 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9277 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
9278 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
9279 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
9281 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9282 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9283 height, False);
9284 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9285 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9286 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
9287 height, False);
9290 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
9291 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
9292 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
9293 example. */
9295 int area_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
9296 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
9297 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
9299 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (f))
9300 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9301 left + area_width - rest, top,
9302 rest, height, False);
9303 else
9304 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9305 left, top, rest, height, False);
9309 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
9310 if (mask)
9312 XWindowChanges wc;
9314 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
9315 wc.y = top;
9316 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
9317 wc.height = height;
9318 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
9319 mask, &wc);
9322 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9324 /* Remember new settings. */
9325 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
9326 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
9327 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
9328 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
9330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9333 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9334 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
9335 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9336 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
9337 dragged. */
9338 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
9340 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
9342 if (whole == 0)
9343 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
9344 else
9346 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
9347 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
9348 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
9351 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9353 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
9357 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
9358 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
9359 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
9360 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
9361 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
9362 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
9363 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
9365 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
9366 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
9367 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
9369 static void
9370 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
9371 FRAME_PTR frame;
9373 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
9374 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
9376 Lisp_Object bar;
9377 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
9378 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
9379 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
9380 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
9381 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
9382 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
9383 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
9388 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
9389 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
9391 static void
9392 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
9393 struct window *window;
9395 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9396 struct frame *f;
9398 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
9399 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9400 abort ();
9402 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
9404 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
9405 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
9406 if (NILP (bar->prev))
9408 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
9409 the lists. */
9410 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9411 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
9412 return;
9413 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
9414 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
9415 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
9416 else
9417 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
9418 one or the other! */
9419 abort ();
9421 else
9422 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
9424 if (! NILP (bar->next))
9425 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
9427 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9428 bar->prev = Qnil;
9429 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
9430 if (! NILP (bar->next))
9431 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
9434 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
9435 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
9437 static void
9438 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
9439 FRAME_PTR f;
9441 Lisp_Object bar, next;
9443 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
9445 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
9446 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
9447 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
9449 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
9451 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9453 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9455 next = b->next;
9456 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
9459 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
9460 and they should get garbage-collected. */
9464 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
9465 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
9467 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9468 mark bits. */
9470 static void
9471 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
9472 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9473 XEvent *event;
9475 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9477 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9478 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9479 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
9480 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
9482 BLOCK_INPUT;
9484 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
9486 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
9487 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
9489 /* x, y, width, height */
9490 0, 0,
9491 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
9492 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
9494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9496 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9499 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
9500 is set to something other than no_event, it is enqueued.
9502 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9503 mark bits. */
9505 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9507 static void
9508 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
9509 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9510 XEvent *event;
9511 struct input_event *emacs_event;
9513 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
9514 abort ();
9516 emacs_event->kind = scroll_bar_click;
9517 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
9518 emacs_event->modifiers
9519 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
9520 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
9521 event->xbutton.state)
9522 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
9523 ? up_modifier
9524 : down_modifier));
9525 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
9526 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
9527 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
9529 #if 0
9530 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9531 int internal_height
9532 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9533 #endif
9534 int top_range
9535 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9536 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
9538 if (y < 0) y = 0;
9539 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
9541 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
9542 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
9543 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
9544 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
9545 else
9546 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
9548 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
9549 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
9550 whether or not we're dragging. */
9551 #if 0
9552 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
9553 holding it. */
9554 if (event->type == ButtonPress
9555 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
9556 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
9557 #endif
9559 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
9560 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
9561 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
9563 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
9564 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
9566 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
9567 bar->dragging = Qnil;
9570 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
9571 #if 0
9572 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
9573 the handle. */
9574 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
9575 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
9576 else
9577 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
9578 #else
9579 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
9580 #endif
9582 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
9586 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
9588 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
9589 mark bits. */
9591 static void
9592 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
9593 struct scroll_bar *bar;
9594 XEvent *event;
9596 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
9598 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
9600 f->mouse_moved = 1;
9601 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
9603 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
9604 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
9606 /* Where should the handle be now? */
9607 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
9609 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
9611 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
9613 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
9618 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9620 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
9621 on the scroll bar. */
9623 static void
9624 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
9625 FRAME_PTR *fp;
9626 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
9627 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
9628 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
9629 unsigned long *time;
9631 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
9632 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
9633 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
9634 int win_x, win_y;
9635 Window dummy_window;
9636 int dummy_coord;
9637 unsigned int dummy_mask;
9639 BLOCK_INPUT;
9641 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
9642 report that. */
9643 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
9645 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
9646 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
9647 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
9649 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
9650 &win_x, &win_y,
9652 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
9653 &dummy_mask))
9655 else
9657 #if 0
9658 int inside_height
9659 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
9660 #endif
9661 int top_range
9662 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
9664 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
9666 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
9667 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
9669 if (win_y < 0)
9670 win_y = 0;
9671 if (win_y > top_range)
9672 win_y = top_range;
9674 *fp = f;
9675 *bar_window = bar->window;
9677 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
9678 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
9679 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
9680 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
9681 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
9682 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
9683 else
9684 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
9686 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
9687 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
9689 f->mouse_moved = 0;
9690 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
9693 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
9695 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9699 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
9700 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
9701 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
9702 redraw them. */
9704 void
9705 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
9706 FRAME_PTR f;
9708 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9709 Lisp_Object bar;
9711 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
9712 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
9713 But in that case we should not clear them. */
9714 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
9715 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
9716 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
9717 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9718 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
9719 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
9720 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9723 /* This processes Expose events from the menu-bar specific X event
9724 loop in xmenu.c. This allows to redisplay the frame if necessary
9725 when handling menu-bar or pop-up items. */
9728 process_expose_from_menu (event)
9729 XEvent event;
9731 FRAME_PTR f;
9732 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9733 int frame_exposed_p = 0;
9735 BLOCK_INPUT;
9737 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (event.xexpose.display);
9738 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
9739 if (f)
9741 if (f->async_visible == 0)
9743 f->async_visible = 1;
9744 f->async_iconified = 0;
9745 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
9746 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9748 else
9750 expose_frame (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window),
9751 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
9752 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
9753 frame_exposed_p = 1;
9756 else
9758 struct scroll_bar *bar
9759 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
9761 if (bar)
9762 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
9765 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9766 return frame_exposed_p;
9769 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
9771 struct selection_event_queue
9773 XEvent event;
9774 struct selection_event_queue *next;
9777 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
9779 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
9781 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
9783 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
9785 static void
9786 x_queue_event (f, event)
9787 FRAME_PTR f;
9788 XEvent *event;
9790 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
9791 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
9793 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
9795 queue_tmp->event = *event;
9796 queue_tmp->next = queue;
9797 queue = queue_tmp;
9801 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
9802 so that they get processed afresh. */
9804 static void
9805 x_unqueue_events (display)
9806 Display *display;
9808 while (queue != NULL)
9810 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
9811 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
9812 queue = queue_tmp->next;
9813 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
9817 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
9819 void
9820 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
9821 Display *display;
9823 x_queue_selection_requests++;
9826 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
9828 void
9829 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
9830 Display *display;
9832 x_queue_selection_requests--;
9833 x_unqueue_events (display);
9836 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
9838 #if 0
9839 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
9840 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
9841 sometimes don't work. */
9843 static Time enter_timestamp;
9844 #endif
9846 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
9847 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
9848 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
9849 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
9851 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
9852 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
9854 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
9856 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
9857 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
9859 static int temp_index;
9860 static short temp_buffer[100];
9862 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
9863 on a particular display. */
9865 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
9867 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
9868 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
9869 We try all the open displays, one by one.
9870 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
9872 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
9874 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
9875 do \
9877 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
9878 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
9879 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
9880 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
9881 if (numchars >= 1) \
9883 bufp->kind = menu_bar_activate_event; \
9884 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f); \
9885 bufp->arg = Qnil; \
9886 bufp++; \
9887 count++; \
9888 numchars--; \
9891 while (0)
9893 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
9894 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
9896 /* Read events coming from the X server.
9897 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
9898 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
9900 Events representing keys are stored in buffer BUFP,
9901 which can hold up to NUMCHARS characters.
9902 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
9903 thus pretending to be `read'.
9905 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
9907 static int
9908 XTread_socket (sd, bufp, numchars, expected)
9909 register int sd;
9910 /* register */ struct input_event *bufp;
9911 /* register */ int numchars;
9912 int expected;
9914 int count = 0;
9915 int nbytes = 0;
9916 XEvent event;
9917 struct frame *f;
9918 int event_found = 0;
9919 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9920 struct coding_system coding;
9922 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
9924 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
9925 return -1;
9928 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
9929 BLOCK_INPUT;
9931 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
9932 input_signal_count++;
9934 if (numchars <= 0)
9935 abort (); /* Don't think this happens. */
9937 ++handling_signal;
9939 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
9940 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
9941 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
9943 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
9944 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
9945 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
9946 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
9947 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
9948 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
9949 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
9950 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
9951 #endif
9953 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
9954 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
9955 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
9956 for X connections. */
9957 #ifndef SIGIO
9958 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
9959 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
9961 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
9962 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
9963 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
9964 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
9966 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
9967 #endif /* SIGIO */
9968 #endif
9970 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
9971 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
9973 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
9974 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
9977 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9978 BLOCK_INPUT;
9979 count += x_session_check_input (bufp, &numchars);
9980 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9981 #endif
9983 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
9985 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
9987 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9989 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
9990 XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
9991 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
9992 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
9993 was created. */
9994 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
9995 event.xclient.window);
9996 if (XFilterEvent (&event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None))
9997 break;
9999 #endif
10000 event_found = 1;
10002 switch (event.type)
10004 case ClientMessage:
10006 if (event.xclient.message_type
10007 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10008 && event.xclient.format == 32)
10010 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10011 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
10013 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
10014 could be the shell widget window
10015 if the frame has no title bar. */
10016 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10017 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10018 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
10019 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10020 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10021 #endif
10022 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
10023 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
10024 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
10025 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
10026 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
10027 needed.
10029 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
10030 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
10031 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
10032 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
10033 Emacs. */
10035 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
10036 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
10037 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
10038 if (f)
10040 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
10041 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
10042 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
10043 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
10044 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
10045 /* The ICCCM says this is
10046 the only valid choice. */
10047 RevertToParent,
10048 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
10049 /* This is needed to detect the error
10050 if there is an error. */
10051 XSync (d, False);
10052 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
10054 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
10055 #endif /* 0 */
10057 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10058 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
10060 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
10061 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
10062 the session manager, who's looking for such a
10063 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
10064 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
10065 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
10066 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
10067 session manager and one for this. */
10068 if (numchars > 0
10069 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10070 && ! x_session_have_connection ()
10071 #endif
10074 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10075 event.xclient.window);
10076 /* This is just so we only give real data once
10077 for a single Emacs process. */
10078 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
10079 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10080 event.xclient.window,
10081 initial_argv, initial_argc);
10082 else if (f)
10083 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10084 event.xclient.window,
10085 0, 0);
10088 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
10089 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
10091 struct frame *f
10092 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10093 event.xclient.window);
10095 if (f)
10097 if (numchars == 0)
10098 abort ();
10100 bufp->kind = delete_window_event;
10101 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10102 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10103 bufp++;
10105 count += 1;
10106 numchars -= 1;
10110 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10111 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
10114 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10115 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
10117 int new_x, new_y;
10118 struct frame *f
10119 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10121 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
10122 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
10124 if (f)
10126 f->output_data.x->left_pos = new_x;
10127 f->output_data.x->top_pos = new_y;
10130 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
10131 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10132 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
10134 struct frame *f
10135 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10136 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
10137 &event, NULL);
10139 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
10140 else if ((event.xclient.message_type
10141 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
10142 || (event.xclient.message_type
10143 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
10145 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
10146 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
10147 currently never do because we are interested in
10148 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
10149 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
10150 struct frame *f
10151 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
10152 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
10153 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
10155 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10156 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
10157 we construct an input_event. */
10158 else if (event.xclient.message_type
10159 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
10161 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, bufp);
10162 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
10163 goto out;
10165 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10166 else
10167 goto OTHER;
10169 break;
10171 case SelectionNotify:
10172 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10173 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
10174 goto OTHER;
10175 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10176 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
10177 break;
10179 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
10180 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10181 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
10182 goto OTHER;
10183 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10185 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
10187 if (numchars == 0)
10188 abort ();
10190 bufp->kind = selection_clear_event;
10191 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
10192 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
10193 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
10194 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
10195 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10196 bufp++;
10198 count += 1;
10199 numchars -= 1;
10201 break;
10203 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
10204 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10205 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
10206 goto OTHER;
10207 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10208 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
10209 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
10210 &event);
10211 else
10213 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
10214 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
10216 if (numchars == 0)
10217 abort ();
10219 bufp->kind = selection_request_event;
10220 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
10221 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (bufp) = eventp->requestor;
10222 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
10223 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (bufp) = eventp->target;
10224 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (bufp) = eventp->property;
10225 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
10226 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
10227 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10228 bufp++;
10230 count += 1;
10231 numchars -= 1;
10233 break;
10235 case PropertyNotify:
10236 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
10237 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
10238 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
10239 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
10240 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
10241 goto OTHER;
10242 #endif
10243 #endif
10244 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
10245 goto OTHER;
10247 case ReparentNotify:
10248 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
10249 if (f)
10251 int x, y;
10252 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
10253 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
10254 f->output_data.x->left_pos = x;
10255 f->output_data.x->top_pos = y;
10257 break;
10259 case Expose:
10260 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
10261 if (f)
10263 x_check_fullscreen (f);
10265 if (f->async_visible == 0)
10267 f->async_visible = 1;
10268 f->async_iconified = 0;
10269 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
10270 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10272 else
10273 expose_frame (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
10274 event.xexpose.window),
10275 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
10276 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
10278 else
10280 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10281 struct scroll_bar *bar;
10282 #endif
10283 #if defined USE_LUCID
10284 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
10285 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
10286 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
10288 Widget widget
10289 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
10290 if (widget)
10291 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
10293 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
10295 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10296 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
10297 goto OTHER;
10298 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10299 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
10301 if (bar)
10302 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
10303 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10304 else
10305 goto OTHER;
10306 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10307 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10309 break;
10311 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
10312 source area was obscured or not
10313 available. */
10314 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
10315 if (f)
10317 expose_frame (f,
10318 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
10319 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
10320 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
10322 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10323 else
10324 goto OTHER;
10325 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10326 break;
10328 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
10329 source area was completely
10330 available. */
10331 break;
10333 case UnmapNotify:
10334 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
10335 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
10337 tip_window = 0;
10338 redo_mouse_highlight ();
10341 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
10342 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
10343 the frame was deleted. */
10345 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
10346 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
10347 display that won't ever be seen. */
10348 f->async_visible = 0;
10349 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
10350 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
10351 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
10352 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
10353 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
10354 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
10355 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
10357 f->async_iconified = 1;
10359 bufp->kind = iconify_event;
10360 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10361 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10362 bufp++;
10363 count++;
10364 numchars--;
10367 goto OTHER;
10369 case MapNotify:
10370 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
10371 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
10372 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
10373 goto OTHER;
10375 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
10376 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
10377 frame is visible. */
10378 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
10379 if (f)
10381 f->async_visible = 1;
10382 f->async_iconified = 0;
10383 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
10385 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
10386 the frame's display structures. */
10387 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10389 if (f->iconified)
10391 bufp->kind = deiconify_event;
10392 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10393 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10394 bufp++;
10395 count++;
10396 numchars--;
10398 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
10399 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
10400 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
10401 to update the frame titles
10402 in case this is the second frame. */
10403 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
10405 goto OTHER;
10407 case KeyPress:
10409 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
10410 if (popup_activated_flag)
10411 goto OTHER;
10413 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
10415 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
10417 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
10418 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10421 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10422 if (f == 0)
10424 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
10425 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
10426 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
10427 event.xkey.window);
10428 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
10430 widget = XtParent (widget);
10431 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
10434 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10436 if (f != 0)
10438 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
10439 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
10440 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
10441 his Emacs hang.
10443 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
10444 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
10445 status_return even if the input is too long to
10446 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
10447 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
10448 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
10449 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
10450 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
10451 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
10452 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
10453 int modifiers;
10454 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
10456 event.xkey.state
10457 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10458 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
10459 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
10461 /* This will have to go some day... */
10463 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
10464 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
10465 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
10466 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
10467 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
10468 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
10469 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
10471 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
10472 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
10473 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
10474 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
10475 not it is combined with Meta. */
10476 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
10477 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
10479 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10480 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
10482 Status status_return;
10484 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
10485 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10486 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10487 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10488 &status_return);
10489 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
10491 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
10492 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
10493 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10494 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10495 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10496 &status_return);
10498 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
10499 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
10500 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
10501 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
10502 coding_system = Qutf_8;
10503 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10504 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10505 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10506 &status_return);
10507 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
10509 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
10510 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
10511 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
10512 &event.xkey,
10513 copy_bufptr,
10514 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10515 &status_return);
10518 #endif
10520 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
10521 break;
10522 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
10524 keysym = NoSymbol;
10525 modifiers = 0;
10527 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
10528 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
10529 abort ();
10531 else
10532 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10533 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10534 &compose_status);
10535 #else
10536 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
10537 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
10538 &compose_status);
10539 #endif
10541 orig_keysym = keysym;
10543 if (numchars > 1)
10545 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
10546 || keysym == XK_Delete
10547 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
10548 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
10549 #endif
10550 || (keysym >= XK_Kanji && keysym <= XK_Eisu_toggle)
10551 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
10552 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
10553 #ifdef HPUX
10554 /* This recognizes the "extended function keys".
10555 It seems there's no cleaner way.
10556 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling mode_switch
10557 incorrectly. */
10558 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
10559 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
10560 #endif
10561 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
10562 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
10563 #endif
10564 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
10565 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
10566 #endif
10567 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
10568 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
10569 #endif
10570 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
10571 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
10572 #endif
10573 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
10574 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
10575 #endif
10576 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
10577 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
10578 #endif
10579 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
10580 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
10581 #endif
10582 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
10583 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
10584 #endif
10585 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
10586 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
10587 #endif
10588 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
10589 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
10590 #endif
10591 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
10592 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
10593 #endif
10594 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
10595 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
10596 #endif
10597 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
10598 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
10599 #endif
10600 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
10601 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
10602 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
10603 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
10604 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
10605 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
10606 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
10607 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
10608 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
10609 #endif
10610 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
10611 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
10612 #endif
10613 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
10614 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock to
10615 XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock doesn't have real
10616 modifiers but should be treated similarly
10617 to Mode_switch by Emacs. */
10618 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
10619 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) >= XK_ISO_Lock
10620 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym) <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
10621 #endif
10624 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short))
10625 temp_index = 0;
10626 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = keysym;
10627 bufp->kind = non_ascii_keystroke;
10628 bufp->code = keysym;
10629 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10630 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10631 bufp->modifiers
10632 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10633 modifiers);
10634 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
10635 bufp++;
10636 count++;
10637 numchars--;
10639 else if (numchars > nbytes)
10641 register int i;
10642 register int c;
10643 int nchars, len;
10645 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
10646 which depends on which X*LookupString function
10647 we used just above and the locale. */
10648 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
10649 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
10650 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
10651 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
10652 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
10653 gives us composition information. */
10654 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
10656 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10658 if (temp_index == (sizeof temp_buffer
10659 / sizeof (short)))
10660 temp_index = 0;
10661 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = copy_bufptr[i];
10665 /* Decode the input data. */
10666 int require;
10667 unsigned char *p;
10669 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
10670 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
10671 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
10672 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p,
10673 nbytes, require);
10674 nbytes = coding.produced;
10675 nchars = coding.produced_char;
10676 copy_bufptr = p;
10679 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
10680 character events. */
10681 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
10683 if (nchars == nbytes)
10684 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
10685 else
10686 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
10687 nbytes - i, len);
10689 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
10690 ? ascii_keystroke
10691 : multibyte_char_keystroke);
10692 bufp->code = c;
10693 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10694 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10695 bufp->modifiers
10696 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
10697 modifiers);
10698 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
10699 bufp++;
10702 count += nchars;
10703 numchars -= nchars;
10705 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
10706 break;
10708 else
10709 abort ();
10711 else
10712 abort ();
10714 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10715 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
10716 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
10717 client. */
10718 break;
10719 #else
10720 goto OTHER;
10721 #endif
10723 case KeyRelease:
10724 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10725 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
10726 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
10727 client. */
10728 break;
10729 #else
10730 goto OTHER;
10731 #endif
10733 /* Here's a possible interpretation of the whole
10734 FocusIn-EnterNotify FocusOut-LeaveNotify mess. If
10735 you get a FocusIn event, you have to get a FocusOut
10736 event before you relinquish the focus. If you
10737 haven't received a FocusIn event, then a mere
10738 LeaveNotify is enough to free you. */
10740 case EnterNotify:
10742 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
10744 #if 0
10745 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
10747 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
10748 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
10749 || !(f->auto_lower)
10750 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
10752 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
10753 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
10756 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10757 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10758 #endif
10760 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
10761 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
10762 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
10763 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
10764 goto OTHER;
10767 case FocusIn:
10768 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xfocus.window);
10769 if (event.xfocus.detail != NotifyPointer)
10770 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = f;
10771 if (f)
10773 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
10775 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
10776 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
10777 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
10778 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
10779 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
10781 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
10782 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
10783 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10784 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
10788 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10789 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10790 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10791 #endif
10793 goto OTHER;
10795 case LeaveNotify:
10796 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
10797 if (f)
10799 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
10801 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
10802 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
10803 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10804 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10807 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
10808 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
10809 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
10810 the mouse leaves the frame. */
10811 if (any_help_event_p)
10813 Lisp_Object frame;
10814 int n;
10816 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10817 help_echo = Qnil;
10818 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars,
10819 Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
10820 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
10823 #if 0
10824 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
10825 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo);
10826 else
10828 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10829 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10830 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10831 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10833 #endif
10835 goto OTHER;
10837 case FocusOut:
10838 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xfocus.window);
10839 if (event.xfocus.detail != NotifyPointer
10840 && f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10841 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10842 if (f && f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10843 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
10845 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10846 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
10847 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
10848 #endif
10850 goto OTHER;
10852 case MotionNotify:
10854 previous_help_echo = help_echo;
10855 help_echo = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
10856 help_echo_pos = -1;
10858 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
10859 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
10860 f = last_mouse_frame;
10861 else
10862 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
10864 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
10866 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10867 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10870 if (f)
10873 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
10874 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
10876 Lisp_Object window;
10877 int area;
10879 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
10880 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
10881 &area, 0);
10883 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
10884 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
10885 will be selected iff it is active. */
10886 if (WINDOWP(window)
10887 && !EQ (window, last_window)
10888 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
10889 && numchars > 0)
10891 bufp->kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
10892 bufp->frame_or_window = window;
10893 bufp->arg = Qnil;
10894 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
10897 last_window=window;
10899 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
10901 else
10903 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10904 struct scroll_bar *bar
10905 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.window);
10907 if (bar)
10908 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
10909 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10911 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
10912 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
10913 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
10916 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo
10917 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
10918 if (!NILP (help_echo)
10919 || !NILP (previous_help_echo))
10921 Lisp_Object frame;
10922 int n;
10924 if (f)
10925 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10926 else
10927 frame = Qnil;
10929 any_help_event_p = 1;
10930 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars, help_echo, frame,
10931 help_echo_window, help_echo_object,
10932 help_echo_pos);
10933 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
10936 goto OTHER;
10939 case ConfigureNotify:
10940 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
10941 if (f)
10943 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10944 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
10945 do this one, the right one will come later.
10946 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
10947 need to reset it below. */
10948 int dont_resize =
10949 ((f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
10950 && FRAME_NEW_WIDTH (f) != 0);
10951 int rows = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, event.xconfigure.height);
10952 int columns = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, event.xconfigure.width);
10953 if (dont_resize)
10954 goto OTHER;
10956 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
10957 is called by the code that handles resizing
10958 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
10960 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
10961 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
10962 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
10963 if (columns != f->width
10964 || rows != f->height
10965 || event.xconfigure.width != f->output_data.x->pixel_width
10966 || event.xconfigure.height != f->output_data.x->pixel_height)
10968 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
10969 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10970 cancel_mouse_face (f);
10972 #endif
10974 f->output_data.x->pixel_width = event.xconfigure.width;
10975 f->output_data.x->pixel_height = event.xconfigure.height;
10977 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
10978 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
10979 x_real_positions (f, &f->output_data.x->left_pos,
10980 &f->output_data.x->top_pos);
10982 x_check_fullscreen_move(f);
10983 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
10984 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen &=
10985 ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
10986 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10987 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
10988 xic_set_statusarea (f);
10989 #endif
10991 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
10993 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
10994 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
10995 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
10996 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
10998 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10999 /* Some window managers pass (0,0) as the location of
11000 the window, and the Motif event handler stores it
11001 in the emacs widget, which messes up Motif menus. */
11002 if (event.xconfigure.x == 0 && event.xconfigure.y == 0)
11004 event.xconfigure.x = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
11005 event.xconfigure.y = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
11007 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
11009 goto OTHER;
11011 case ButtonPress:
11012 case ButtonRelease:
11014 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
11015 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
11016 struct input_event emacs_event;
11017 int tool_bar_p = 0;
11019 emacs_event.kind = no_event;
11020 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
11022 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
11023 && last_mouse_frame
11024 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
11025 f = last_mouse_frame;
11026 else
11027 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
11029 if (f)
11031 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
11032 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11033 && XFASTINT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->height))
11035 Lisp_Object window;
11036 int p, x, y;
11038 x = event.xbutton.x;
11039 y = event.xbutton.y;
11041 /* Set x and y. */
11042 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &p, 1);
11043 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
11045 x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, &event.xbutton);
11046 tool_bar_p = 1;
11050 if (!tool_bar_p)
11051 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
11052 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
11053 construct_mouse_click (&emacs_event, &event, f);
11055 else
11057 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11058 struct scroll_bar *bar
11059 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.window);
11061 if (bar)
11062 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
11063 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
11066 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
11068 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
11069 last_mouse_frame = f;
11070 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
11071 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
11072 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
11073 the ButtonPress. */
11074 if (f != 0)
11075 f->mouse_moved = 0;
11077 if (!tool_bar_p)
11078 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11080 else
11082 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
11085 if (numchars >= 1 && emacs_event.kind != no_event)
11087 bcopy (&emacs_event, bufp, sizeof (struct input_event));
11088 bufp++;
11089 count++;
11090 numchars--;
11093 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11094 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
11095 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
11096 don't pass it to Xt right now.
11097 Instead, save it away
11098 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
11099 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
11100 if (f && event.type == ButtonPress
11101 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
11102 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
11103 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
11104 && event.xbutton.x < f->output_data.x->pixel_width
11105 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
11106 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
11107 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
11109 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
11110 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
11112 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
11114 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
11115 goto OTHER;
11118 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
11119 but I am trying to be cautious. */
11120 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
11122 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
11124 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
11125 if (f->output_data.x)
11126 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
11128 else
11129 goto OTHER;
11131 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
11132 else
11133 goto OTHER;
11134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11136 break;
11138 case CirculateNotify:
11139 goto OTHER;
11141 case CirculateRequest:
11142 goto OTHER;
11144 case VisibilityNotify:
11145 goto OTHER;
11147 case MappingNotify:
11148 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
11149 local cache. */
11150 switch (event.xmapping.request)
11152 case MappingModifier:
11153 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
11154 /* This is meant to fall through. */
11155 case MappingKeyboard:
11156 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
11158 goto OTHER;
11160 default:
11161 OTHER:
11162 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11163 BLOCK_INPUT;
11164 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
11165 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11166 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11167 break;
11172 out:;
11174 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
11175 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
11176 if (! event_found)
11178 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
11179 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
11180 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
11181 x_noop_count++;
11182 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
11184 x_noop_count=0;
11186 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
11187 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
11189 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
11191 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
11192 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
11196 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
11197 raise it now. */
11198 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
11199 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
11201 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
11202 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
11205 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11206 --handling_signal;
11207 return count;
11213 /***********************************************************************
11214 Text Cursor
11215 ***********************************************************************/
11217 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
11218 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
11219 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
11220 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
11221 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
11222 are window-relative. */
11224 static void
11225 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, area, x0, x1, y0, y1)
11226 struct window *w;
11227 enum glyph_row_area area;
11228 int x0, y0, x1, y1;
11230 if (area == TEXT_AREA && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11232 int cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
11233 int cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
11234 int cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
11235 int cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
11237 if (x0 <= cx0 && (x1 < 0 || x1 >= cx1))
11239 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
11240 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
11241 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
11242 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
11243 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
11244 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
11245 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
11246 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
11247 over the cursor image.
11249 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
11250 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
11251 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
11252 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
11253 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
11255 if (((y0 >= cy0 && y0 < cy1) || (y1 > cy0 && y1 < cy1))
11256 && w->current_matrix->rows[w->phys_cursor.vpos].displays_text_p)
11257 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
11263 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
11264 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
11265 WHOLE_LINE_P non-zero means include the areas used for truncation
11266 mark display and alike in the clipping rectangle.
11268 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
11269 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
11270 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
11272 static void
11273 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, whole_line_p)
11274 struct window *w;
11275 struct glyph_row *row;
11276 GC gc;
11277 int whole_line_p;
11279 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
11280 XRectangle clip_rect;
11281 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
11283 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
11285 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
11286 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
11287 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
11288 clip_rect.width = window_width;
11289 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
11291 /* If clipping to the whole line, including trunc marks, extend
11292 the rectangle to the left and increase its width. */
11293 if (whole_line_p)
11295 clip_rect.x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
11296 clip_rect.width += FRAME_X_FRINGE_WIDTH (f);
11299 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
11303 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
11305 static void
11306 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
11307 struct window *w;
11308 struct glyph_row *row;
11310 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
11311 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11312 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
11313 int x, y, wd, h;
11314 XGCValues xgcv;
11315 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11316 GC gc;
11318 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
11319 coordinates. */
11320 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
11321 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
11322 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
11323 h = row->height - 1;
11325 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
11326 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
11327 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11328 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11329 return;
11331 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
11332 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
11333 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
11334 width instead. */
11335 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
11336 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
11337 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
11338 wd = min (CANON_X_UNIT (f), wd);
11339 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
11341 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
11342 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
11343 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
11344 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
11345 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
11346 else
11347 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11348 GCForeground, &xgcv);
11349 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
11351 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
11352 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
11353 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
11354 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
11358 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
11360 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
11361 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
11362 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
11363 --gerd. */
11365 static void
11366 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
11367 struct window *w;
11368 struct glyph_row *row;
11369 int width;
11370 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
11372 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
11373 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11375 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
11376 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
11377 and mini-buffer. */
11378 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11379 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11380 return;
11382 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
11383 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
11384 the bar might not be in the window. */
11385 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
11387 struct glyph_row *row;
11388 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
11389 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
11391 else
11393 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
11394 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
11395 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
11396 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
11397 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
11398 XGCValues xgcv;
11400 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
11401 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
11402 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
11403 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
11404 that the glyph is legible. */
11405 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
11406 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
11407 else
11408 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
11409 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
11411 if (gc)
11412 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
11413 else
11415 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
11416 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
11419 if (width < 0)
11420 width = f->output_data.x->cursor_width;
11421 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
11423 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
11424 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
11426 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
11427 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
11428 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
11429 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
11430 width, row->height);
11431 else
11432 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
11433 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
11434 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
11435 row->height - width),
11436 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
11437 width);
11439 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
11444 /* Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
11445 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
11446 is is about to be rewritten. */
11448 static void
11449 x_clear_cursor (w)
11450 struct window *w;
11452 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11453 x_update_window_cursor (w, 0);
11457 /* Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
11458 comment of x_draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
11460 static void
11461 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, hl)
11462 struct window *w;
11463 struct glyph_row *row;
11464 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
11466 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
11467 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
11468 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
11469 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])
11471 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
11472 int x1;
11474 x1 = x_draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA,
11475 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.hpos + 1,
11476 hl, 0);
11477 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
11479 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
11480 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
11482 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
11483 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
11484 are redrawn. */
11485 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
11487 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
11488 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
11489 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA);
11491 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
11492 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
11493 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA);
11499 /* Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
11501 static void
11502 x_erase_phys_cursor (w)
11503 struct window *w;
11505 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
11506 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11507 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
11508 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
11509 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
11510 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
11511 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
11512 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
11513 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
11515 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
11516 screen. */
11517 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
11518 goto mark_cursor_off;
11520 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
11521 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
11522 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
11523 goto mark_cursor_off;
11525 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
11526 can do. */
11527 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
11528 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
11529 goto mark_cursor_off;
11531 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
11532 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
11533 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
11534 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
11535 goto mark_cursor_off;
11537 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
11538 In this case, either x_draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
11539 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
11540 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
11541 cursor glyph at hand. */
11542 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
11543 goto mark_cursor_off;
11545 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
11546 we clear the cursor. */
11547 if (! NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
11548 && w == XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
11549 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11550 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11551 && hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
11552 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11553 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11554 && hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
11555 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
11556 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
11557 mouse highlighting does not. */
11558 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos)
11559 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
11561 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
11562 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
11564 int x;
11565 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
11567 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
11568 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
11569 goto mark_cursor_off;
11571 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
11573 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11575 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
11576 cursor_row->y)),
11577 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
11578 cursor_row->visible_height,
11579 False);
11582 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
11583 if (mouse_face_here_p)
11584 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
11585 else
11586 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
11587 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
11589 mark_cursor_off:
11590 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
11591 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11595 /* Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
11597 static int
11598 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (w)
11599 struct window *w;
11601 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
11602 int in_mouse_face = 0;
11604 if (WINDOWP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
11605 && XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window) == w)
11607 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
11608 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
11610 if (vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11611 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11612 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
11613 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
11614 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
11615 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
11616 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
11617 in_mouse_face = 1;
11620 return in_mouse_face;
11624 /* Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
11625 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
11626 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
11628 void
11629 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
11630 struct window *w;
11631 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
11633 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
11634 int new_cursor_type;
11635 int new_cursor_width;
11636 struct glyph_matrix *current_glyphs;
11637 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
11638 struct glyph *glyph;
11640 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
11641 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
11642 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
11643 window. */
11644 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
11645 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
11646 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
11647 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
11648 return;
11650 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
11651 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
11652 return;
11654 current_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
11655 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_glyphs, vpos);
11656 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
11658 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
11659 display the cursor. */
11660 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
11662 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
11663 return;
11666 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
11668 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. In a
11669 mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we are
11670 reading input from this window. For the selected window, we want
11671 the cursor type given by the frame parameter. If explicitly
11672 marked off, draw no cursor. In all other cases, we want a hollow
11673 box cursor. */
11674 new_cursor_width = -1;
11675 if (cursor_in_echo_area
11676 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
11677 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
11679 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
11680 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
11681 else if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qcursor_in_non_selected_windows,
11682 w->buffer)))
11683 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
11684 else
11685 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11687 else
11689 if (f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame
11690 || w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
11692 if ((MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
11693 || NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qcursor_in_non_selected_windows,
11694 w->buffer))
11695 || NILP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->cursor_type))
11696 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11697 else
11698 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
11700 else
11702 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
11704 if (EQ (b->cursor_type, Qt))
11705 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
11706 else
11707 new_cursor_type = x_specified_cursor_type (b->cursor_type,
11708 &new_cursor_width);
11709 if (w->cursor_off_p)
11711 if (new_cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
11712 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
11713 else if (new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && new_cursor_width > 1)
11714 new_cursor_width = 1;
11715 else
11716 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
11721 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
11722 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
11723 erase it. */
11724 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
11725 && (!on
11726 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
11727 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
11728 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
11729 || (new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR
11730 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
11731 x_erase_phys_cursor (w);
11733 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
11734 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
11735 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
11736 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
11737 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
11738 if (on)
11740 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
11741 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
11743 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
11744 of them may need the information. */
11745 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
11746 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
11747 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11748 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11749 w->phys_cursor_type = new_cursor_type;
11750 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
11752 switch (new_cursor_type)
11754 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
11755 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
11756 break;
11758 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
11759 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
11760 break;
11762 case BAR_CURSOR:
11763 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
11764 break;
11766 case HBAR_CURSOR:
11767 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
11768 break;
11770 case NO_CURSOR:
11771 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
11772 break;
11774 default:
11775 abort ();
11778 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11779 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
11780 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
11781 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
11782 #endif
11785 #ifndef XFlush
11786 if (updating_frame != f)
11787 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11788 #endif
11792 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it. X and Y are window
11793 relative pixel coordinates. HPOS and VPOS are glyph matrix
11794 positions. If W is not the selected window, display a hollow
11795 cursor. ON non-zero means display the cursor at X, Y which
11796 correspond to HPOS, VPOS, otherwise it is cleared. */
11798 void
11799 x_display_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
11800 struct window *w;
11801 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
11803 BLOCK_INPUT;
11804 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11805 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11809 /* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
11810 Don't change the cursor's position. */
11812 void
11813 x_update_cursor (f, on_p)
11814 struct frame *f;
11816 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
11820 /* Call x_update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
11821 in the window tree rooted at W. */
11823 static void
11824 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (w, on_p)
11825 struct window *w;
11826 int on_p;
11828 while (w)
11830 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
11831 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
11832 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
11833 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
11834 else
11835 x_update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
11837 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
11842 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
11843 of ON. */
11845 static void
11846 x_update_window_cursor (w, on)
11847 struct window *w;
11848 int on;
11850 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
11851 of being deleted. */
11852 if (w->current_matrix)
11854 BLOCK_INPUT;
11855 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
11856 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
11857 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11864 /* Icons. */
11866 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
11869 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
11870 struct frame *f;
11871 Lisp_Object file;
11873 int bitmap_id;
11875 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
11876 return 1;
11878 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
11879 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
11880 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
11881 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
11883 if (STRINGP (file))
11884 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
11885 else
11887 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
11888 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
11889 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
11890 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
11891 gnu_width, gnu_height);
11893 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
11894 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
11895 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
11896 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
11897 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
11899 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
11902 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
11903 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
11905 return 0;
11909 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
11910 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
11913 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
11914 struct frame *f;
11915 char *icon_name;
11917 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
11918 return 1;
11920 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
11922 XTextProperty text;
11923 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
11924 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
11925 text.format = 8;
11926 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
11927 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11928 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
11929 &text);
11930 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11931 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), &text);
11932 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11934 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
11935 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
11936 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
11938 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
11939 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
11940 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
11941 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
11943 return 0;
11946 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
11948 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
11949 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
11951 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
11953 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
11954 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
11955 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
11957 static void
11958 x_error_catcher (display, error)
11959 Display *display;
11960 XErrorEvent *error;
11962 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
11963 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data,
11964 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
11967 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
11968 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
11969 operating on.
11971 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
11972 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
11973 stored in x_error_message_string.
11975 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
11976 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
11978 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
11980 void x_check_errors ();
11981 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
11984 x_catch_errors (dpy)
11985 Display *dpy;
11987 int count = specpdl_ptr - specpdl;
11989 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
11990 XSync (dpy, False);
11992 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind, x_error_message_string);
11994 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
11995 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
11997 return count;
12000 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
12002 static Lisp_Object
12003 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
12004 Lisp_Object old_val;
12006 x_error_message_string = old_val;
12007 return Qnil;
12010 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
12011 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
12012 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
12014 void
12015 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
12016 Display *dpy;
12017 char *format;
12019 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
12020 XSync (dpy, False);
12022 if (XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0])
12023 error (format, XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data);
12026 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
12027 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
12030 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
12031 Display *dpy;
12033 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
12034 XSync (dpy, False);
12036 return XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] != 0;
12039 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
12041 void
12042 x_clear_errors (dpy)
12043 Display *dpy;
12045 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
12048 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
12049 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
12050 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
12051 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
12053 void
12054 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
12055 Display *dpy;
12056 int count;
12058 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
12061 #if 0
12062 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
12063 x_trace_wire ()
12065 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
12067 #endif /* ! 0 */
12070 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
12071 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
12072 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
12073 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
12074 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
12076 static SIGTYPE
12077 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
12078 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
12080 #ifdef USG
12081 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
12082 must reestablish each time */
12083 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
12084 #endif /* USG */
12088 /************************************************************************
12089 Handling X errors
12090 ************************************************************************/
12092 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
12094 static char *error_msg;
12096 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
12097 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
12098 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
12100 static void
12101 x_fatal_error_signal ()
12103 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
12104 exit (70);
12107 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
12108 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
12110 static SIGTYPE
12111 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
12112 Display *dpy;
12113 char *error_message;
12115 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
12116 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
12117 int count;
12119 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
12120 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
12121 handling_signal = 0;
12123 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
12124 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
12125 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
12126 the original message here. */
12127 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
12129 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
12130 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
12131 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
12133 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
12134 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
12135 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
12137 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
12138 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
12140 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
12141 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
12142 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
12144 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12145 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
12146 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
12147 if (dpyinfo)
12149 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
12150 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
12151 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
12152 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
12154 #endif
12156 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
12157 if (dpyinfo)
12158 dpyinfo->display = 0;
12160 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
12161 that are on the dead display. */
12162 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12164 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
12165 minibuf_frame
12166 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
12167 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
12168 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
12169 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
12170 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
12171 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
12174 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
12175 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
12176 for another frame that we need to delete. */
12177 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12178 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
12179 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
12181 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
12182 trying to find a replacement. */
12183 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
12184 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
12187 if (dpyinfo)
12188 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
12190 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
12192 if (x_display_list == 0)
12194 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
12195 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
12196 exit (70);
12199 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
12200 #ifdef SIGIO
12201 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
12202 #endif
12203 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
12204 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12206 clear_waiting_for_input ();
12207 error ("%s", error_msg);
12211 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
12212 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
12213 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
12215 static void
12216 x_error_quitter (display, error)
12217 Display *display;
12218 XErrorEvent *error;
12220 char buf[256], buf1[356];
12222 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
12223 original error handler. */
12225 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
12226 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
12227 buf, error->request_code);
12228 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
12232 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
12233 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
12235 static int
12236 x_error_handler (display, error)
12237 Display *display;
12238 XErrorEvent *error;
12240 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
12241 x_error_catcher (display, error);
12242 else
12243 x_error_quitter (display, error);
12244 return 0;
12247 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
12248 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
12249 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
12251 static int
12252 x_io_error_quitter (display)
12253 Display *display;
12255 char buf[256];
12257 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
12258 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
12259 return 0;
12262 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
12264 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
12265 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
12266 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
12267 The return value shows which font we chose. */
12269 Lisp_Object
12270 x_new_font (f, fontname)
12271 struct frame *f;
12272 register char *fontname;
12274 struct font_info *fontp
12275 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
12277 if (!fontp)
12278 return Qnil;
12280 f->output_data.x->font = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
12281 f->output_data.x->baseline_offset = fontp->baseline_offset;
12282 f->output_data.x->fontset = -1;
12284 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
12286 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
12287 if (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width > 0)
12289 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12290 f->scroll_bar_cols = (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width + wid-1) / wid;
12292 else
12294 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12295 f->scroll_bar_cols = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
12298 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
12299 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
12301 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
12302 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12303 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
12304 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12305 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
12306 f->output_data.x->font->fid);
12308 frame_update_line_height (f);
12310 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
12311 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
12312 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
12313 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
12314 x_set_window_size (f, 0, f->width, f->height);
12316 else
12317 /* If we are setting a new frame's font for the first time,
12318 there are no faces yet, so this font's height is the line height. */
12319 f->output_data.x->line_height = FONT_HEIGHT (f->output_data.x->font);
12321 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
12324 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
12325 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
12326 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
12327 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
12329 Lisp_Object
12330 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
12331 struct frame *f;
12332 char *fontsetname;
12334 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
12335 Lisp_Object result;
12337 if (fontset < 0)
12338 return Qnil;
12340 if (f->output_data.x->fontset == fontset)
12341 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
12342 to do. */
12343 return fontset_name (fontset);
12345 result = x_new_font (f, (XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data));
12347 if (!STRINGP (result))
12348 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
12349 return Qnil;
12351 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
12352 f->output_data.x->fontset = fontset;
12354 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12355 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
12356 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
12357 xic_set_xfontset (f, XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data);
12358 #endif
12360 return build_string (fontsetname);
12363 /* Compute actual fringe widths */
12365 void
12366 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, redraw)
12367 struct frame *f;
12368 int redraw;
12370 int o_left = f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width;
12371 int o_right = f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width;
12372 int o_cols = f->output_data.x->fringe_cols;
12374 Lisp_Object left_fringe = Fassq (Qleft_fringe, f->param_alist);
12375 Lisp_Object right_fringe = Fassq (Qright_fringe, f->param_alist);
12376 int left_fringe_width, right_fringe_width;
12378 if (!NILP (left_fringe))
12379 left_fringe = Fcdr (left_fringe);
12380 if (!NILP (right_fringe))
12381 right_fringe = Fcdr (right_fringe);
12383 left_fringe_width = ((NILP (left_fringe) || !INTEGERP (left_fringe)) ? 8 :
12384 XINT (left_fringe));
12385 right_fringe_width = ((NILP (right_fringe) || !INTEGERP (right_fringe)) ? 8 :
12386 XINT (right_fringe));
12388 if (left_fringe_width || right_fringe_width)
12390 int left_wid = left_fringe_width >= 0 ? left_fringe_width : -left_fringe_width;
12391 int right_wid = right_fringe_width >= 0 ? right_fringe_width : -right_fringe_width;
12392 int conf_wid = left_wid + right_wid;
12393 int font_wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
12394 int cols = (left_wid + right_wid + font_wid-1) / font_wid;
12395 int real_wid = cols * font_wid;
12396 if (left_wid && right_wid)
12398 if (left_fringe_width < 0)
12400 /* Left fringe width is fixed, adjust right fringe if necessary */
12401 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = left_wid;
12402 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = real_wid - left_wid;
12404 else if (right_fringe_width < 0)
12406 /* Right fringe width is fixed, adjust left fringe if necessary */
12407 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = real_wid - right_wid;
12408 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = right_wid;
12410 else
12412 /* Adjust both fringes with an equal amount.
12413 Note that we are doing integer arithmetic here, so don't
12414 lose a pixel if the total width is an odd number. */
12415 int fill = real_wid - conf_wid;
12416 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = left_wid + fill/2;
12417 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = right_wid + fill - fill/2;
12420 else if (left_fringe_width)
12422 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = real_wid;
12423 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = 0;
12425 else
12427 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = 0;
12428 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = real_wid;
12430 f->output_data.x->fringe_cols = cols;
12431 f->output_data.x->fringes_extra = real_wid;
12433 else
12435 f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width = 0;
12436 f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width = 0;
12437 f->output_data.x->fringe_cols = 0;
12438 f->output_data.x->fringes_extra = 0;
12441 if (redraw && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
12442 if (o_left != f->output_data.x->left_fringe_width ||
12443 o_right != f->output_data.x->right_fringe_width ||
12444 o_cols != f->output_data.x->fringe_cols)
12445 redraw_frame (f);
12448 /***********************************************************************
12449 X Input Methods
12450 ***********************************************************************/
12452 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12454 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12456 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
12457 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
12458 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
12460 static void
12461 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
12462 XIM xim;
12463 XPointer client_data;
12464 XPointer call_data;
12466 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
12467 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
12469 BLOCK_INPUT;
12471 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
12472 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12474 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12475 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
12477 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
12478 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
12480 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
12481 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
12486 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
12487 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12488 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
12489 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12492 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
12494 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
12495 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
12497 static void
12498 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
12499 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12500 char *resource_name;
12502 #ifdef USE_XIM
12503 XIM xim;
12505 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
12506 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
12508 if (xim)
12510 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12511 XIMCallback destroy;
12512 #endif
12514 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
12515 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
12517 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
12518 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
12519 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
12520 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0. */
12521 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
12522 #endif
12525 #else /* not USE_XIM */
12526 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12527 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
12531 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
12533 struct xim_inst_t
12535 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12536 char *resource_name;
12539 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
12540 server is available. DISPLAY is teh display of the XIM.
12541 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
12542 when the callback was registered. */
12544 static void
12545 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
12546 Display *display;
12547 XPointer client_data;
12548 XPointer call_data;
12550 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
12551 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
12553 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
12554 if (dpyinfo->xim)
12555 return;
12557 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
12559 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
12560 as they have no XIC. */
12561 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
12563 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
12565 BLOCK_INPUT;
12566 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12568 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12570 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
12571 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
12573 create_frame_xic (f);
12574 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
12575 xic_set_statusarea (f);
12576 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
12578 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
12579 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
12584 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12588 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12591 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
12592 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
12593 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
12594 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
12596 static void
12597 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
12598 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12599 char *resource_name;
12601 #ifdef USE_XIM
12602 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
12603 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
12604 int len;
12606 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12607 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
12608 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
12609 len = strlen (resource_name);
12610 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
12611 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
12612 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
12613 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
12614 xim_instantiate_callback,
12615 /* Fixme: This is XPointer in
12616 XFree86 but (XPointer *) on
12617 Tru64, at least. */
12618 (XPointer) xim_inst);
12619 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12620 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12621 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
12622 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12624 #else /* not USE_XIM */
12625 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12626 #endif /* not USE_XIM */
12630 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
12632 static void
12633 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
12634 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
12636 #ifdef USE_XIM
12637 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
12638 if (dpyinfo->display)
12639 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
12640 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
12641 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
12642 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12643 if (dpyinfo->display)
12644 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
12645 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
12646 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
12647 #endif /* USE_XIM */
12650 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
12654 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
12655 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
12657 void
12658 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
12659 struct frame *f;
12661 Window child;
12662 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
12663 int flags = f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags;
12664 int this_window;
12666 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
12667 is already for the top-left corner. */
12668 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
12669 return;
12671 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12672 this_window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
12673 #else
12674 this_window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
12675 #endif
12677 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
12678 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
12679 But do this only if we will need the results. */
12680 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
12682 int count;
12684 BLOCK_INPUT;
12685 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12686 while (1)
12688 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12689 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
12691 /* From-window, to-window. */
12692 this_window,
12693 f->output_data.x->parent_desc,
12695 /* From-position, to-position. */
12696 0, 0, &win_x, &win_y,
12698 /* Child of win. */
12699 &child);
12700 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
12702 Window newroot, newparent = 0xdeadbeef;
12703 Window *newchildren;
12704 unsigned int nchildren;
12706 if (! XQueryTree (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), this_window, &newroot,
12707 &newparent, &newchildren, &nchildren))
12708 break;
12710 XFree ((char *) newchildren);
12712 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = newparent;
12714 else
12715 break;
12718 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
12719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12722 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
12723 position that fits on the screen. */
12724 if (flags & XNegative)
12725 f->output_data.x->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
12726 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width - win_x
12727 - PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
12728 + f->output_data.x->left_pos);
12731 int height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
12733 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
12734 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
12735 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
12737 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
12738 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
12739 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
12740 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
12741 is right, though.
12743 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
12744 2000-12-01, gerd. */
12746 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
12747 #endif
12749 if (flags & YNegative)
12750 f->output_data.x->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
12751 - 2 * f->output_data.x->border_width
12752 - win_y
12753 - height
12754 + f->output_data.x->top_pos);
12757 /* The left_pos and top_pos
12758 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
12759 so the flags should correspond. */
12760 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
12763 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
12764 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
12765 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
12766 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
12767 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
12769 void
12770 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
12771 struct frame *f;
12772 register int xoff, yoff;
12773 int change_gravity;
12775 int modified_top, modified_left;
12777 if (change_gravity > 0)
12779 f->output_data.x->top_pos = yoff;
12780 f->output_data.x->left_pos = xoff;
12781 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
12782 if (xoff < 0)
12783 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
12784 if (yoff < 0)
12785 f->output_data.x->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
12786 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
12788 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
12790 BLOCK_INPUT;
12791 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
12793 modified_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12794 modified_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12795 #if 0 /* Running on psilocin (Debian), and displaying on the NCD X-terminal,
12796 this seems to be unnecessary and incorrect. rms, 4/17/97. */
12797 /* It is a mystery why we need to add the border_width here
12798 when the frame is already visible, but experiment says we do. */
12799 if (change_gravity != 0)
12801 modified_left += f->output_data.x->border_width;
12802 modified_top += f->output_data.x->border_width;
12804 #endif
12806 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12807 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
12808 modified_left, modified_top);
12809 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12810 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
12811 modified_left, modified_top);
12812 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12813 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12816 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
12817 If so needed, resize the frame. */
12818 static void
12819 x_check_fullscreen (f)
12820 struct frame *f;
12822 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
12824 int width, height, ign;
12826 x_real_positions (f, &f->output_data.x->left_pos,
12827 &f->output_data.x->top_pos);
12829 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
12831 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
12832 when setting WM manager hints.
12833 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
12834 x_check_fullscreen_move. */
12835 if (f->width != width || f->height != height)
12837 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
12838 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
12839 cancel_mouse_face (f);
12841 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
12842 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
12848 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
12849 the window. This is done in xfns.c.
12850 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
12851 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
12852 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
12853 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
12854 static void
12855 x_check_fullscreen_move (f)
12856 struct frame *f;
12858 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT)
12860 int expect_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12861 int expect_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12863 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
12864 expect_top = 0;
12865 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
12866 expect_left = 0;
12868 if (expect_top != f->output_data.x->top_pos
12869 || expect_left != f->output_data.x->left_pos)
12870 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
12872 /* Just do this once */
12873 f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen &= ~FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT;
12878 /* Calculate fullscreen size. Return in *TOP_POS and *LEFT_POS the
12879 wanted positions of the WM window (not emacs window).
12880 Return in *WIDTH and *HEIGHT the wanted width and height of Emacs
12881 window (FRAME_X_WINDOW).
12883 void
12884 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, width, height, top_pos, left_pos)
12885 struct frame *f;
12886 int *width;
12887 int *height;
12888 int *top_pos;
12889 int *left_pos;
12891 int newwidth = f->width, newheight = f->height;
12893 *top_pos = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
12894 *left_pos = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
12896 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
12898 int ph;
12900 ph = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height;
12901 newheight = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, ph);
12902 ph = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, newheight)
12903 - f->output_data.x->y_pixels_diff;
12904 newheight = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, ph);
12905 *top_pos = 0;
12908 if (f->output_data.x->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
12910 int pw;
12912 pw = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width;
12913 newwidth = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, pw);
12914 pw = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, newwidth)
12915 - f->output_data.x->x_pixels_diff;
12916 newwidth = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, pw);
12917 *left_pos = 0;
12920 *width = newwidth;
12921 *height = newheight;
12925 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
12926 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
12927 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
12928 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
12930 static void
12931 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
12932 struct frame *f;
12933 int change_gravity;
12934 int cols, rows;
12936 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
12938 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
12939 f->output_data.x->vertical_scroll_bar_extra
12940 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
12942 : FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0
12943 ? FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
12944 : (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font)));
12946 x_compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
12948 pixelwidth = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
12949 pixelheight = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
12951 f->output_data.x->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
12952 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
12954 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
12955 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
12956 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
12958 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
12959 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
12960 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
12961 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
12963 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
12964 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
12965 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
12966 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
12967 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
12969 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
12970 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
12971 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
12972 PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
12973 PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
12975 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
12976 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
12977 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
12978 we have to make sure to do it here. */
12979 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
12981 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
12985 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
12986 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
12987 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
12988 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
12990 void
12991 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
12992 struct frame *f;
12993 int change_gravity;
12994 int cols, rows;
12996 BLOCK_INPUT;
12998 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13000 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
13002 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
13003 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
13004 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
13005 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
13006 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
13007 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
13008 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
13009 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
13010 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
13012 else
13013 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
13015 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13017 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
13019 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13021 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
13022 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
13024 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
13025 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
13026 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
13027 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
13028 cancel_mouse_face (f);
13030 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13033 /* Mouse warping. */
13035 void
13036 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
13037 struct frame *f;
13038 int x, y;
13040 int pix_x, pix_y;
13042 pix_x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, x) + FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font) / 2;
13043 pix_y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, y) + f->output_data.x->line_height / 2;
13045 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
13046 if (pix_x > PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
13048 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
13049 if (pix_y > PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
13051 BLOCK_INPUT;
13053 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13054 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
13055 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13058 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
13060 void
13061 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
13062 struct frame *f;
13063 int pix_x, pix_y;
13065 BLOCK_INPUT;
13067 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13068 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
13069 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13072 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
13074 void
13075 x_focus_on_frame (f)
13076 struct frame *f;
13078 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
13079 x_raise_frame (f);
13080 #endif
13081 #if 0
13082 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
13083 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
13084 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
13085 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
13086 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
13087 #endif /* ! 0 */
13090 void
13091 x_unfocus_frame (f)
13092 struct frame *f;
13094 #if 0
13095 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
13096 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
13097 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
13098 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
13099 #endif /* ! 0 */
13102 /* Raise frame F. */
13104 void
13105 x_raise_frame (f)
13106 struct frame *f;
13108 if (f->async_visible)
13110 BLOCK_INPUT;
13111 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13112 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
13113 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13114 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13115 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13116 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13117 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13121 /* Lower frame F. */
13123 void
13124 x_lower_frame (f)
13125 struct frame *f;
13127 if (f->async_visible)
13129 BLOCK_INPUT;
13130 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13131 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget));
13132 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13133 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13134 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13135 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13136 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13140 static void
13141 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
13142 FRAME_PTR f;
13143 int raise_flag;
13145 if (raise_flag)
13146 x_raise_frame (f);
13147 else
13148 x_lower_frame (f);
13151 /* Change of visibility. */
13153 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
13154 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
13155 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
13156 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
13157 but it will become visible later when the window manager
13158 finishes with it. */
13160 void
13161 x_make_frame_visible (f)
13162 struct frame *f;
13164 Lisp_Object type;
13165 int original_top, original_left;
13166 int retry_count = 2;
13168 retry:
13170 BLOCK_INPUT;
13172 type = x_icon_type (f);
13173 if (!NILP (type))
13174 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
13176 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13178 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
13179 call x_set_offset a second time
13180 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
13181 before the window gets really visible. */
13182 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
13183 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
13184 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
13186 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
13188 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13189 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
13190 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13191 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
13192 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13193 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13194 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13195 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13196 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
13197 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
13198 to come back ok without this. */
13199 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
13200 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13201 #endif
13204 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13206 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
13207 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
13208 so that incoming events are handled. */
13210 Lisp_Object frame;
13211 int count;
13212 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
13213 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
13214 will set it when they are handled. */
13215 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
13217 original_left = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13218 original_top = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13220 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
13221 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13223 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
13225 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
13226 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
13227 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
13228 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
13230 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
13231 because the window manager may choose the position
13232 and we don't want to override it. */
13234 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
13235 && f->output_data.x->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
13236 && previously_visible)
13238 Drawable rootw;
13239 int x, y;
13240 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
13242 BLOCK_INPUT;
13244 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
13245 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
13246 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
13247 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
13248 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
13249 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
13250 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
13251 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
13252 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
13254 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
13255 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
13256 original_left, original_top);
13258 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13261 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
13263 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
13264 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
13265 MapNotify at all.. */
13266 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
13267 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
13269 /* Force processing of queued events. */
13270 x_sync (f);
13272 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
13273 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
13274 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
13275 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
13276 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
13277 probably a bug. */
13278 if (input_polling_used ())
13280 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
13281 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
13282 handler reset it. */
13283 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
13284 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
13285 poll_suppress_count = 1;
13286 poll_for_input_1 ();
13287 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
13290 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
13291 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13294 /* 2000-09-28: In
13296 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
13297 (iconify-frame f)
13298 (raise-frame f))
13300 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
13301 FreeBSD, Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
13302 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
13303 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
13305 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
13306 goto retry;
13310 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
13312 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
13314 void
13315 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
13316 struct frame *f;
13318 Window window;
13320 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13321 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
13322 window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
13323 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13324 window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13325 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13327 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
13328 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
13329 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13331 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
13332 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
13333 return;
13334 #endif
13336 BLOCK_INPUT;
13338 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
13339 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
13340 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
13341 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
13342 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
13343 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
13345 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13347 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
13348 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
13350 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13351 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
13353 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
13355 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
13356 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13358 XEvent unmap;
13360 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
13361 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
13362 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13363 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
13364 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13365 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
13366 False,
13367 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
13368 &unmap))
13370 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13371 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
13375 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
13376 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
13377 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
13379 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
13380 just by the event that we get from the server.
13381 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
13382 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
13383 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
13384 f->visible = 0;
13385 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
13386 f->async_visible = 0;
13387 f->async_iconified = 0;
13389 x_sync (f);
13391 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13394 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
13396 void
13397 x_iconify_frame (f)
13398 struct frame *f;
13400 int result;
13401 Lisp_Object type;
13403 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
13404 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
13405 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13407 if (f->async_iconified)
13408 return;
13410 BLOCK_INPUT;
13412 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13414 type = x_icon_type (f);
13415 if (!NILP (type))
13416 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
13418 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13420 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13422 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
13423 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
13424 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
13425 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13426 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
13427 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
13428 so we have to record it here. */
13429 f->iconified = 1;
13430 f->visible = 1;
13431 f->async_iconified = 1;
13432 f->async_visible = 0;
13433 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13434 return;
13437 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13438 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
13439 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
13440 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13442 if (!result)
13443 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
13445 f->async_iconified = 1;
13446 f->async_visible = 0;
13449 BLOCK_INPUT;
13450 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13451 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13452 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13454 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
13455 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
13456 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
13457 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
13459 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
13460 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
13462 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
13463 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
13465 XEvent message;
13467 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13468 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
13469 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
13470 message.xclient.format = 32;
13471 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
13473 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
13474 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
13475 False,
13476 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
13477 &message))
13479 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
13480 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
13484 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
13485 IconicState. */
13486 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
13488 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13490 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
13491 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13494 f->async_iconified = 1;
13495 f->async_visible = 0;
13497 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13498 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13499 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13503 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
13505 void
13506 x_free_frame_resources (f)
13507 struct frame *f;
13509 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
13510 Lisp_Object bar;
13511 struct scroll_bar *b;
13513 BLOCK_INPUT;
13515 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
13516 commands to the X server. */
13517 if (dpyinfo->display)
13519 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
13520 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
13522 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13523 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
13524 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
13525 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
13526 toolkit scroll bars. */
13527 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
13529 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
13530 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
13532 #endif
13534 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
13535 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
13536 free_frame_xic (f);
13537 #endif
13539 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13540 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
13542 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
13543 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
13545 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
13546 we are using a toolkit. */
13547 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
13548 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13550 free_frame_menubar (f);
13551 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13552 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
13553 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
13554 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13556 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
13557 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
13558 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
13559 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
13560 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
13561 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
13563 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
13564 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
13565 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
13566 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
13567 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
13568 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
13569 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
13570 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
13571 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
13572 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
13573 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
13574 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
13575 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
13576 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
13577 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
13579 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
13580 free_frame_faces (f);
13582 x_free_gcs (f);
13583 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
13586 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
13587 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
13589 xfree (f->output_data.x);
13590 f->output_data.x = NULL;
13592 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
13593 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
13594 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
13595 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
13596 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
13597 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
13599 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
13601 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
13602 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
13603 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
13604 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
13605 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
13606 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
13607 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
13610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
13614 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
13616 void
13617 x_destroy_window (f)
13618 struct frame *f;
13620 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
13622 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
13623 commands to the X server. */
13624 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
13625 x_free_frame_resources (f);
13627 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
13631 /* Setting window manager hints. */
13633 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
13634 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
13635 that the window now has.
13636 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
13637 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0). */
13639 void
13640 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
13641 struct frame *f;
13642 long flags;
13643 int user_position;
13645 XSizeHints size_hints;
13647 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13648 Arg al[2];
13649 int ac = 0;
13650 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
13651 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
13652 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13653 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13654 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13656 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
13657 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
13659 size_hints.x = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
13660 size_hints.y = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
13662 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13663 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
13664 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
13665 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
13666 size_hints.height = widget_height;
13667 size_hints.width = widget_width;
13668 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13669 size_hints.height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
13670 size_hints.width = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
13671 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13673 size_hints.width_inc = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
13674 size_hints.height_inc = f->output_data.x->line_height;
13675 size_hints.max_width
13676 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
13677 size_hints.max_height
13678 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
13680 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
13682 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
13683 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
13684 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13686 int base_width, base_height;
13687 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
13689 base_width = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
13690 base_height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
13692 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
13694 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
13695 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
13696 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
13697 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
13698 zero-row, zero-column frame.
13700 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
13701 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
13702 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
13704 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13705 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
13706 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
13707 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
13708 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
13709 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
13710 #else
13711 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
13712 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
13713 #endif
13716 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
13717 if (flags)
13719 size_hints.flags |= flags;
13720 goto no_read;
13722 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13725 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
13726 long supplied_return;
13727 int value;
13729 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13730 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
13731 &supplied_return);
13732 #else
13733 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
13734 #endif
13736 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13737 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
13738 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
13739 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
13740 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
13741 #endif
13743 if (flags)
13744 size_hints.flags |= flags;
13745 else
13747 if (value == 0)
13748 hints.flags = 0;
13749 if (hints.flags & PSize)
13750 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
13751 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
13752 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
13753 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
13754 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
13755 if (hints.flags & USSize)
13756 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
13760 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13761 no_read:
13762 #endif
13764 #ifdef PWinGravity
13765 size_hints.win_gravity = f->output_data.x->win_gravity;
13766 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
13768 if (user_position)
13770 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
13771 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
13773 #endif /* PWinGravity */
13775 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
13776 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
13777 #else
13778 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
13779 #endif
13782 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
13784 void
13785 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
13786 struct frame *f;
13787 int state;
13789 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13790 Arg al[1];
13792 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
13793 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
13794 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13795 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13797 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
13798 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
13800 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
13801 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13804 void
13805 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
13806 struct frame *f;
13807 int pixmap_id;
13809 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
13811 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13812 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13813 #endif
13815 if (pixmap_id > 0)
13817 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
13818 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
13820 else
13822 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
13823 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
13824 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
13825 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
13826 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
13827 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
13828 best to explicitly give up. */
13829 #if 0
13830 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
13831 #else
13832 return;
13833 #endif
13836 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
13839 Arg al[1];
13840 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
13841 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
13844 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13846 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
13847 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
13849 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
13852 void
13853 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
13854 struct frame *f;
13855 int icon_x, icon_y;
13857 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
13858 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
13859 #else
13860 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
13861 #endif
13863 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
13864 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
13865 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
13867 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
13871 /***********************************************************************
13872 Fonts
13873 ***********************************************************************/
13875 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
13877 struct font_info *
13878 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
13879 FRAME_PTR f;
13880 int font_idx;
13882 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
13886 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
13888 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
13889 to be listed.
13891 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
13893 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
13894 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
13895 on how many fonts to match. */
13897 Lisp_Object
13898 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
13899 struct frame *f;
13900 Lisp_Object pattern;
13901 int size;
13902 int maxnames;
13904 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
13905 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
13906 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
13907 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
13908 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
13909 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
13910 int count;
13911 int allow_scalable_fonts_p = 0;
13913 if (size < 0)
13915 allow_scalable_fonts_p = 1;
13916 size = 0;
13919 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
13920 if (NILP (patterns))
13921 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
13923 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
13924 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
13925 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
13927 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
13929 int num_fonts;
13930 char **names = NULL;
13932 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
13933 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
13934 The cache is an alist of the form:
13935 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
13936 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
13937 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
13938 allow_scalable_fonts_p ? Qt : Qnil);
13939 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
13940 if (!NILP (list))
13942 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
13943 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
13944 goto label_cached;
13947 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
13949 BLOCK_INPUT;
13950 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
13952 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
13954 XFontStruct *font;
13955 unsigned long value;
13957 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, XSTRING (pattern)->data);
13958 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
13960 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
13961 server. Let's just ignore it. */
13962 font = NULL;
13963 x_clear_errors (dpy);
13966 if (font
13967 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
13969 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
13970 int len = strlen (name);
13971 char *tmp;
13973 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
13974 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
13975 string. We must avoid such a name. */
13976 if (len == 0)
13977 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
13978 else
13980 num_fonts = 1;
13981 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
13982 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
13983 simple var. */
13984 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
13985 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
13986 XFree (name);
13989 else
13990 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
13992 if (font)
13993 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
13996 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
13998 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
13999 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
14000 names = XListFonts (dpy, XSTRING (pattern)->data, max (maxnames, 10),
14001 &num_fonts);
14002 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
14004 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14005 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14006 names = NULL;
14007 x_clear_errors (dpy);
14011 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14012 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14014 if (names)
14016 int i;
14018 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
14019 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
14020 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
14022 int width = 0;
14023 char *p = names[i];
14024 int average_width = -1, dashes = 0;
14026 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
14027 14 dashes, and the field value following 12th dash
14028 (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a auto-scaled font which
14029 is usually too ugly to be used for editing. Let's
14030 ignore it. */
14031 while (*p)
14032 if (*p++ == '-')
14034 dashes++;
14035 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
14036 width = atoi (p);
14037 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
14038 average_width = atoi (p);
14041 if (allow_scalable_fonts_p
14042 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0)
14044 tem = build_string (names[i]);
14045 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
14047 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
14048 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
14049 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
14050 >= 0))
14051 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
14052 width of this font. */
14053 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
14054 else
14055 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
14056 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
14061 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
14063 BLOCK_INPUT;
14064 XFreeFontNames (names);
14065 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14069 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
14070 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14071 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14073 label_cached:
14074 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
14076 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
14077 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
14078 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
14080 int found_size;
14082 tem = XCAR (list);
14084 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
14085 continue;
14086 if (!size)
14088 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
14089 continue;
14092 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
14094 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
14095 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
14096 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
14098 BLOCK_INPUT;
14099 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
14100 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
14101 XSTRING (XCAR (tem))->data);
14102 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
14104 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14105 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14106 thisinfo = NULL;
14107 x_clear_errors (dpy);
14109 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14110 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14112 if (thisinfo)
14114 XSETCDR (tem,
14115 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
14116 ? make_number (0)
14117 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
14118 BLOCK_INPUT;
14119 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
14120 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14122 else
14123 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
14124 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
14125 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
14126 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
14129 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
14130 if (found_size == size)
14131 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
14132 else if (found_size > 0)
14134 if (NILP (second_best))
14135 second_best = tem;
14136 else if (found_size < size)
14138 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
14139 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
14140 second_best = tem;
14142 else
14144 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
14145 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
14146 second_best = tem;
14150 if (!NILP (newlist))
14151 break;
14152 else if (!NILP (second_best))
14154 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
14155 break;
14159 return newlist;
14163 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
14165 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
14166 font table. */
14168 static void
14169 x_check_font (f, font)
14170 struct frame *f;
14171 XFontStruct *font;
14173 int i;
14174 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14176 xassert (font != NULL);
14178 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14179 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14180 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
14181 break;
14183 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
14186 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
14188 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
14189 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
14190 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
14191 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
14192 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
14194 static INLINE void
14195 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
14196 XFontStruct *font;
14197 int *w, *h;
14199 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
14200 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
14202 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
14203 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
14204 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
14205 if (*w <= 0)
14206 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
14210 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
14211 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
14212 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
14213 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
14214 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
14216 static int
14217 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
14218 struct frame *f;
14220 int i;
14221 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14222 XFontStruct *font;
14223 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
14224 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
14226 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
14227 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
14229 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
14230 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
14232 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
14233 int w, h;
14235 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
14236 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
14237 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
14239 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
14240 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
14243 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
14244 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
14246 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
14247 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
14248 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
14252 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
14253 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
14254 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
14255 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
14257 struct font_info *
14258 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
14259 struct frame *f;
14260 register char *fontname;
14261 int size;
14263 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14264 Lisp_Object font_names;
14265 int count;
14267 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
14268 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
14269 we already have by comparing names. */
14270 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
14272 if (!NILP (font_names))
14274 Lisp_Object tail;
14275 int i;
14277 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14278 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
14279 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14280 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
14281 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)
14282 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
14283 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)))
14284 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
14287 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
14289 char *full_name;
14290 XFontStruct *font;
14291 struct font_info *fontp;
14292 unsigned long value;
14293 int i;
14295 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
14296 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
14297 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
14298 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
14299 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
14300 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
14301 fontname = (char *) XSTRING (XCAR (font_names))->data;
14303 BLOCK_INPUT;
14304 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14305 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
14306 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
14308 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
14309 server. Let's just ignore it. */
14310 font = NULL;
14311 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
14313 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
14314 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14315 if (!font)
14316 return NULL;
14318 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
14319 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
14320 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
14321 break;
14323 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
14324 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
14325 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
14327 int sz;
14328 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
14329 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
14330 dpyinfo->font_table
14331 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
14334 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
14335 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
14336 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
14338 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
14339 BLOCK_INPUT;
14340 fontp->font = font;
14341 fontp->font_idx = i;
14342 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
14343 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
14345 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
14346 full_name = 0;
14347 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
14349 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
14350 char *p = name;
14351 int dashes = 0;
14353 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
14354 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
14355 so don't use it.
14356 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
14357 stored in them. */
14358 while (*p)
14360 if (*p == '-')
14361 dashes++;
14362 p++;
14365 if (dashes >= 13)
14367 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
14368 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
14371 XFree (name);
14374 if (full_name != 0)
14375 fontp->full_name = full_name;
14376 else
14377 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
14379 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
14380 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
14382 if (NILP (font_names))
14384 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
14385 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
14386 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
14387 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
14388 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
14389 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
14390 Qnil);
14392 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14393 Fcons (Fcons (key,
14394 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
14395 make_number (fontp->size)),
14396 Qnil)),
14397 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14398 if (full_name)
14400 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
14401 Qnil);
14402 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
14403 Fcons (Fcons (key,
14404 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
14405 make_number (fontp->size)),
14406 Qnil)),
14407 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
14411 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
14412 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
14413 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
14414 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
14415 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
14416 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
14417 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
14418 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
14419 fontp->encoding[1]
14420 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
14421 /* 1-byte font */
14422 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14423 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14424 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
14425 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
14426 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
14427 /* 2-byte font */
14428 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
14429 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
14430 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14431 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14432 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
14433 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
14434 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
14435 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
14436 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14437 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
14438 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
14439 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
14440 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
14442 fontp->baseline_offset
14443 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
14444 ? (long) value : 0);
14445 fontp->relative_compose
14446 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
14447 ? (long) value : 0);
14448 fontp->default_ascent
14449 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
14450 ? (long) value : 0);
14452 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
14453 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
14454 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
14455 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
14456 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
14457 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
14458 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14459 return fontp;
14464 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
14465 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
14467 struct font_info *
14468 x_query_font (f, fontname)
14469 struct frame *f;
14470 register char *fontname;
14472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
14473 int i;
14475 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
14476 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
14477 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
14478 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
14479 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
14480 return NULL;
14484 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
14485 `encoder' of the structure. */
14487 void
14488 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
14489 struct font_info *fontp;
14491 Lisp_Object list, elt;
14493 elt = Qnil;
14494 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
14496 elt = XCAR (list);
14497 if (CONSP (elt)
14498 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
14499 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
14500 >= 0)
14501 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
14502 >= 0)))
14503 break;
14506 if (! NILP (list))
14508 struct ccl_program *ccl
14509 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
14511 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
14512 xfree (ccl);
14513 else
14514 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
14520 /***********************************************************************
14521 Initialization
14522 ***********************************************************************/
14524 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14525 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
14526 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
14527 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
14529 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
14530 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
14531 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
14533 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14534 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14535 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14536 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14537 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14538 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
14539 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
14541 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14543 static int x_initialized;
14545 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
14546 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
14547 the screen number from the server number. */
14548 static int
14549 same_x_server (name1, name2)
14550 char *name1, *name2;
14552 int seen_colon = 0;
14553 unsigned char *system_name = XSTRING (Vsystem_name)->data;
14554 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
14555 int length_until_period = 0;
14557 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
14558 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
14559 length_until_period++;
14561 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
14562 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
14563 name1 += 4;
14564 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
14565 name2 += 4;
14566 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
14567 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
14568 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
14569 name1 += system_name_length;
14570 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
14571 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
14572 name2 += system_name_length;
14573 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
14574 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
14575 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
14576 name1 += length_until_period;
14577 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
14578 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
14579 name2 += length_until_period;
14581 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
14583 if (*name1 == ':')
14584 seen_colon++;
14585 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
14586 return 1;
14588 return (seen_colon
14589 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
14590 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
14592 #endif
14594 struct x_display_info *
14595 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
14596 Lisp_Object display_name;
14597 char *xrm_option;
14598 char *resource_name;
14600 int connection;
14601 Display *dpy;
14602 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
14603 XrmDatabase xrdb;
14605 BLOCK_INPUT;
14607 if (!x_initialized)
14609 x_initialize ();
14610 x_initialized = 1;
14613 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
14614 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
14615 errors with X11R5:
14616 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
14617 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
14618 So let's not use it until R6. */
14619 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
14620 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
14621 #endif
14624 int argc = 0;
14625 char *argv[3];
14627 argv[0] = "";
14628 argc = 1;
14629 if (xrm_option)
14631 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
14632 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
14634 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, XSTRING (display_name)->data,
14635 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
14636 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
14637 &argc, argv);
14639 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
14640 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
14641 fixup_locale ();
14642 #endif
14645 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14646 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
14647 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
14648 #endif
14649 dpy = XOpenDisplay (XSTRING (display_name)->data);
14650 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
14652 /* Detect failure. */
14653 if (dpy == 0)
14655 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14656 return 0;
14659 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
14661 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
14662 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
14664 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
14666 struct x_display_info *share;
14667 Lisp_Object tail;
14669 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
14670 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
14671 if (same_x_server (XSTRING (XCAR (XCAR (tail)))->data,
14672 XSTRING (display_name)->data))
14673 break;
14674 if (share)
14675 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
14676 else
14678 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
14679 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
14680 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
14682 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
14683 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14684 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
14685 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
14686 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
14687 BLOCK_INPUT;
14690 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
14691 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
14692 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
14693 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
14694 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
14695 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
14696 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
14698 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
14700 #endif
14702 /* Put this display on the chain. */
14703 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
14704 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
14706 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
14707 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
14708 x_display_name_list);
14709 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
14711 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
14713 #if 0
14714 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
14715 #endif /* ! 0 */
14717 dpyinfo->x_id_name
14718 = (char *) xmalloc (STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (Vinvocation_name))
14719 + STRING_BYTES (XSTRING (Vsystem_name))
14720 + 2);
14721 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
14722 XSTRING (Vinvocation_name)->data, XSTRING (Vsystem_name)->data);
14724 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
14725 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
14727 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
14728 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
14729 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
14731 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
14732 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
14733 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
14734 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
14735 #else
14736 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
14737 #endif
14738 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
14739 all versions. */
14740 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
14742 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
14743 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
14744 select_visual (dpyinfo);
14745 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14746 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14747 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14748 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14749 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
14750 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
14751 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
14752 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
14753 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
14754 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
14755 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
14756 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
14757 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
14758 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
14759 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
14760 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
14761 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
14762 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
14763 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
14764 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
14765 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
14766 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
14767 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
14768 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
14769 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
14770 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
14771 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
14772 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
14774 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
14775 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
14777 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
14779 Lisp_Object value;
14780 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
14781 build_string ("privateColormap"),
14782 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
14783 Qnil, Qnil);
14784 if (STRINGP (value)
14785 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
14786 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
14787 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
14790 else
14791 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
14792 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
14795 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
14796 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14797 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14798 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
14799 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14800 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
14801 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
14804 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
14805 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
14806 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
14807 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
14808 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
14809 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
14810 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
14811 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
14812 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
14813 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
14814 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
14815 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
14816 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
14817 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
14818 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
14819 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
14820 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
14821 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
14822 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
14823 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
14824 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
14825 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
14826 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
14827 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
14828 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
14829 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
14830 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
14831 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
14832 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
14833 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
14834 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
14835 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
14836 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
14837 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
14838 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
14839 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
14840 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
14841 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
14842 /* For properties of font. */
14843 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
14844 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
14845 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
14846 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
14847 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
14848 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
14849 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
14850 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
14852 /* Ghostscript support. */
14853 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
14854 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
14856 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
14857 False);
14859 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
14861 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
14862 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
14865 char null_bits[1];
14867 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
14869 dpyinfo->null_pixel
14870 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
14871 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
14876 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
14877 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
14878 dpyinfo->gray
14879 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
14880 gray_bitmap_bits,
14881 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
14882 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
14885 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
14886 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
14887 #endif
14889 #ifdef subprocesses
14890 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
14891 if (connection != 0)
14892 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
14893 #endif
14895 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
14896 #ifdef F_SETOWN
14897 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
14898 /* stdin is a socket here */
14899 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
14900 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
14901 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
14902 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
14903 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
14904 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
14906 #ifdef SIGIO
14907 if (interrupt_input)
14908 init_sigio (connection);
14909 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
14911 #ifdef USE_LUCID
14912 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
14913 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
14914 so that Xt does not crash. */
14916 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
14917 XrmValue d, fr, to;
14918 Font font;
14919 int count;
14921 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
14922 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
14923 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
14924 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
14925 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
14926 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
14927 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
14928 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
14929 abort ();
14930 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
14931 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
14932 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
14934 #endif
14935 #endif
14937 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
14938 for debugging X code. */
14940 Lisp_Object value;
14941 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
14942 build_string ("synchronous"),
14943 build_string ("Synchronous"),
14944 Qnil, Qnil);
14945 if (STRINGP (value)
14946 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
14947 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
14948 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
14951 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
14953 return dpyinfo;
14956 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
14957 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
14959 void
14960 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
14961 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
14963 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
14965 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
14966 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
14967 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
14968 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
14969 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
14970 else
14972 Lisp_Object tail;
14974 tail = x_display_name_list;
14975 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
14977 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
14979 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
14980 break;
14982 tail = XCDR (tail);
14986 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
14987 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
14989 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
14990 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
14991 else
14993 struct x_display_info *tail;
14995 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
14996 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
14997 tail->next = tail->next->next;
15000 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
15001 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
15002 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
15003 #endif
15004 #endif
15005 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
15006 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
15007 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
15008 #endif
15009 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
15010 if (dpyinfo->xim)
15011 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
15012 #endif
15014 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
15015 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
15016 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
15017 xfree (dpyinfo);
15021 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
15023 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
15025 x_produce_glyphs,
15026 x_write_glyphs,
15027 x_insert_glyphs,
15028 x_clear_end_of_line,
15029 x_scroll_run,
15030 x_after_update_window_line,
15031 x_update_window_begin,
15032 x_update_window_end,
15033 XTcursor_to,
15034 x_flush,
15035 x_clear_mouse_face,
15036 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
15037 x_fix_overlapping_area
15040 void
15041 x_initialize ()
15043 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
15045 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
15046 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
15047 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
15048 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
15049 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
15050 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
15051 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
15052 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
15053 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
15054 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
15055 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
15056 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
15057 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
15058 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
15059 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
15060 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
15061 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
15062 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
15063 estimate_mode_line_height_hook = x_estimate_mode_line_height;
15065 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
15066 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
15067 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
15068 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
15069 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
15070 off the bottom */
15071 baud_rate = 19200;
15073 x_noop_count = 0;
15074 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
15075 any_help_event_p = 0;
15077 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
15078 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
15080 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
15081 XtToolkitInitialize ();
15083 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
15085 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
15086 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
15087 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
15088 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
15089 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
15090 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
15091 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
15093 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
15095 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
15096 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
15097 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
15098 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
15099 widgets don't behave normally. */
15101 EMACS_TIME interval;
15102 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
15103 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
15105 #endif
15107 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
15108 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
15109 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
15110 #endif
15112 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
15113 original error handler. */
15114 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
15115 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
15117 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
15118 #ifdef SIGWINCH
15119 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
15120 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
15122 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
15124 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
15125 x_session_initialize ();
15126 #endif
15130 void
15131 syms_of_xterm ()
15133 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
15134 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
15136 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
15137 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
15139 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
15140 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
15142 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
15143 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
15145 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
15146 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
15147 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
15148 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
15150 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
15151 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
15153 help_echo = Qnil;
15154 staticpro (&help_echo);
15155 help_echo_object = Qnil;
15156 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
15157 help_echo_window = Qnil;
15158 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
15159 previous_help_echo = Qnil;
15160 staticpro (&previous_help_echo);
15161 help_echo_pos = -1;
15163 DEFVAR_BOOL ("mouse-autoselect-window", &mouse_autoselect_window,
15164 doc: /* *Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer. */);
15165 mouse_autoselect_window = 0;
15167 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", &x_stretch_cursor_p,
15168 doc: /* *Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
15169 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
15170 wide as that tab on the display. */);
15171 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
15173 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
15174 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
15175 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
15176 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
15177 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
15178 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
15179 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
15181 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
15182 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
15183 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
15184 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
15185 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
15186 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
15187 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
15188 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
15189 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
15190 #else
15191 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
15192 #endif
15193 #else
15194 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
15195 #endif
15197 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
15198 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
15200 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
15201 Qalt = intern ("alt");
15202 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
15203 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
15204 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
15205 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
15206 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
15207 Qsuper = intern ("super");
15208 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
15210 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
15211 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
15212 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15213 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
15214 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
15215 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
15217 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
15218 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
15219 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15220 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
15221 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
15222 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
15224 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
15225 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
15226 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15227 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
15228 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
15229 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
15231 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
15232 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
15233 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
15234 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
15235 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
15236 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
15240 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */